Fix use of uninitialized variable.
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blob333132b92cb3957f1b7d6cdbf341a974f4376da5
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <signal.h>
25 #include <stdio.h>
26 #include <setjmp.h>
28 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
30 #include "lisp.h"
31 #include "blockinput.h"
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
39 #include "xterm.h"
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
44 #ifndef makedev
45 #include <sys/types.h>
46 #endif /* makedev */
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
50 #include "systime.h"
52 #include <fcntl.h>
53 #include <ctype.h>
54 #include <errno.h>
55 #include <setjmp.h>
56 #include <sys/stat.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
60 #include "charset.h"
61 #include "character.h"
62 #include "coding.h"
63 #include "frame.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
65 #include "fontset.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
67 #include "termopts.h"
68 #include "termchar.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
70 #include "disptab.h"
71 #include "buffer.h"
72 #include "window.h"
73 #include "keyboard.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
75 #include "process.h"
76 #include "atimer.h"
77 #include "keymap.h"
78 #include "font.h"
79 #include "fontset.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
84 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
86 #endif
88 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
89 #include <sys/time.h>
90 #endif
92 #include <unistd.h>
94 #ifdef USE_GTK
95 #include "gtkutil.h"
96 #endif
98 #ifdef USE_LUCID
99 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
100 #endif
102 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
103 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
104 #define HACK_EDITRES
105 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
106 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
108 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
110 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
111 #if defined USE_MOTIF
112 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
113 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
114 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
116 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
119 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
120 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
123 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
124 #ifndef XtNpickTop
125 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
126 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
127 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
128 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
130 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
132 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
133 #include "widget.h"
134 #ifndef XtNinitialState
135 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
136 #endif
137 #endif
139 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
140 #ifdef USE_XIM
141 int use_xim = 1;
142 #else
143 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
144 #endif
148 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
149 start. */
151 static int any_help_event_p;
153 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
154 static Lisp_Object last_window;
156 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
157 use. */
159 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
161 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
162 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
163 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
164 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
166 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
168 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
169 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
170 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
171 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
173 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
175 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
177 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
179 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
181 static struct {
182 struct frame *f;
183 int eventtype;
184 } pending_event_wait;
186 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
187 /* The application context for Xt use. */
188 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
189 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
191 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
193 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
194 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
196 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
197 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
198 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
200 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
202 /* Mouse movement.
204 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
205 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
206 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
207 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
209 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
211 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
212 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
213 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
214 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
215 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
216 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
217 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
218 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
219 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
220 is off. */
222 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
224 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
225 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
226 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
228 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
230 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
231 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
232 an ordinary motion.
234 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
235 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
236 event. */
238 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
240 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
241 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
242 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
243 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
244 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
245 it's somewhat accurate. */
247 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
249 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
251 static Time last_user_time;
253 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
254 events. */
256 #ifdef __STDC__
257 static int volatile input_signal_count;
258 #else
259 static int input_signal_count;
260 #endif
262 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
264 static int x_noop_count;
266 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
268 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
269 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
271 #ifdef USE_GTK
272 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
273 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
275 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
276 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
277 #endif
279 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
280 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
282 enum xembed_info
284 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
287 enum xembed_message
289 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
290 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
291 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
292 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
293 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
294 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
295 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
296 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
298 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
299 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
300 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
301 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
302 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
305 /* Used in x_flush. */
307 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
308 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
309 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
310 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
311 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
312 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
314 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
315 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
316 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
317 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
318 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
319 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
320 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
321 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
322 static void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int) NO_RETURN;
323 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
324 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
325 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
326 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
327 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
328 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
329 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
330 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
331 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
332 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
333 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
334 enum text_cursor_kinds);
336 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
337 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
338 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
339 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
340 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
341 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
342 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
343 enum scroll_bar_part *,
344 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
345 Time *);
346 static void x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
347 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
348 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
349 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
350 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
351 int *, struct input_event *);
352 #ifdef USE_GTK
353 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
354 #endif
355 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
356 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
357 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
358 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
359 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
360 static void x_initialize (void);
363 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
365 static void
366 x_flush (struct frame *f)
368 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
369 connection may be broken. */
370 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
371 return;
373 BLOCK_INPUT;
374 if (f == NULL)
376 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
377 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
378 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
379 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
381 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
382 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
383 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
387 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
388 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
389 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
390 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
391 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
392 performance. */
394 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
397 /***********************************************************************
398 Debugging
399 ***********************************************************************/
401 #if 0
403 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
404 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
406 struct record
408 char *locus;
409 int type;
412 struct record event_record[100];
414 int event_record_index;
416 void
417 record_event (char *locus, int type)
419 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
420 event_record_index = 0;
422 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
423 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
424 event_record_index++;
427 #endif /* 0 */
431 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
433 struct x_display_info *
434 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
436 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
438 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
439 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
440 return dpyinfo;
442 return 0;
445 static Window
446 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
448 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
449 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
450 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
452 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
454 Window root;
455 Window *children;
456 unsigned int nchildren;
458 win = wi;
459 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
460 XFree (children);
463 return win;
466 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
468 void
469 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
471 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
472 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
473 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
474 double alpha = 1.0;
475 double alpha_min = 1.0;
476 unsigned long opac;
477 Window parent;
479 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
480 alpha = f->alpha[0];
481 else
482 alpha = f->alpha[1];
484 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
485 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
486 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
487 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
489 if (alpha < 0.0)
490 return;
491 else if (alpha > 1.0)
492 alpha = 1.0;
493 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
494 alpha = alpha_min;
496 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
498 x_catch_errors (dpy);
500 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
501 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
502 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
503 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
505 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
506 if (parent != None)
507 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
508 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
509 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
511 /* return unless necessary */
513 unsigned char *data;
514 Atom actual;
515 int rc, format;
516 unsigned long n, left;
518 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
519 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
520 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
521 &data);
523 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
525 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
526 XFree ((void *) data);
527 if (value == opac)
529 x_uncatch_errors ();
530 return;
535 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
536 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
537 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
538 x_uncatch_errors ();
542 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
544 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
548 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
550 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
554 /***********************************************************************
555 Starting and ending an update
556 ***********************************************************************/
558 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
559 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
560 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
561 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
562 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
564 static void
565 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
567 /* Nothing to do. */
571 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
572 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
573 position of W. */
575 static void
576 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
578 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
579 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
581 updated_window = w;
582 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
584 BLOCK_INPUT;
586 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
588 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
589 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
591 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
592 highlighting. */
593 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
594 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
597 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
601 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
603 static void
604 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
606 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
607 struct face *face;
609 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
610 if (face)
611 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
612 face->foreground);
614 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
615 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
618 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
620 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
621 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
623 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
624 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
625 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
627 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
628 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
629 here. */
631 static void
632 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
634 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
636 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
638 BLOCK_INPUT;
640 if (cursor_on_p)
641 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
642 output_cursor.vpos,
643 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
645 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
646 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
648 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
651 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
652 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
653 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
655 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
656 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
657 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
660 updated_window = NULL;
664 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
665 update_end. */
667 static void
668 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
670 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
671 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
673 #ifndef XFlush
674 BLOCK_INPUT;
675 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
676 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
677 #endif
681 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
682 complete update has been performed. The global variable
683 updated_window is not available here. */
685 static void
686 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
688 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
690 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
692 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
693 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
695 BLOCK_INPUT;
696 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
697 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
698 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
699 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
700 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
701 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
707 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
708 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
709 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
710 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
711 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
712 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
714 static void
715 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
717 struct window *w = updated_window;
718 struct frame *f;
719 int width, height;
721 xassert (w);
723 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
724 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
726 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
727 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
728 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
729 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
730 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
731 overhead is very small. */
732 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
733 && desired_row->full_width_p
734 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
735 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
736 width != 0)
737 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
738 height > 0))
740 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
742 BLOCK_INPUT;
743 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
744 0, y, width, height, False);
745 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
746 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
747 y, width, height, False);
748 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
752 static void
753 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
755 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
756 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
757 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
758 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
759 struct face *face = p->face;
761 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
762 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
764 if (!p->overlay_p)
766 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
768 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
769 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
770 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
771 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
772 if (face->stipple)
773 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
774 else
775 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
777 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
778 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
779 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
780 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
781 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
782 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
783 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
784 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
786 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
788 if (sb_width > 0)
790 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
791 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
792 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
794 if (bx < 0)
796 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
797 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
798 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
799 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
800 bx = bar_area_x;
801 if (bx >= 0)
803 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
805 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
806 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
807 row->y));
808 ny = row->visible_height;
811 else
813 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
815 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
816 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
818 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
819 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
823 #endif
824 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
825 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
827 if (!face->stipple)
828 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
831 if (p->which)
833 char *bits;
834 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
835 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
836 XGCValues gcv;
838 if (p->wd > 8)
839 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
840 else
841 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
843 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
844 by the server. */
845 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
846 (p->cursor_p
847 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
848 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
849 : face->foreground),
850 face->background, depth);
852 if (p->overlay_p)
854 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
855 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
856 bits, p->wd, p->h,
857 1, 0, 1);
858 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
859 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
860 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
861 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
864 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
865 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
866 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
868 if (p->overlay_p)
870 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
871 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
872 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
876 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
881 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
882 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
883 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
884 rarely happens). */
886 static void
887 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
891 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
892 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
894 static void
895 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
900 /***********************************************************************
901 Glyph display
902 ***********************************************************************/
906 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
907 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
908 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
909 int);
910 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
911 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
912 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
913 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
914 static void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int) NO_RETURN;
915 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
916 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
917 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
918 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
919 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
920 unsigned long *, double, int);
921 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
922 double, int, unsigned long);
923 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
924 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
925 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
926 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
927 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
928 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
929 int, int, int);
930 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
931 int, int, int, int, int, int,
932 XRectangle *);
933 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
934 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
935 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
937 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
938 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
939 #endif
942 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
943 face. */
945 static void
946 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
948 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
949 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
950 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
951 && !s->cmp)
952 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
953 else
955 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
956 XGCValues xgcv;
957 unsigned long mask;
959 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
960 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
962 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
963 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
964 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
965 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
966 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
967 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
968 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
970 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
971 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
972 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
974 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
975 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
978 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
979 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
980 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
982 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
983 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
984 mask, &xgcv);
985 else
986 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
987 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
989 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
994 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
996 static void
997 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
999 int face_id;
1000 struct face *face;
1002 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1003 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1004 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1005 if (face == NULL)
1006 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1008 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1009 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
1010 else
1011 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
1012 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1013 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1015 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1016 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1017 else
1019 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1020 except for FONT. */
1021 XGCValues xgcv;
1022 unsigned long mask;
1024 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1025 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1026 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1027 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1029 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1030 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1031 mask, &xgcv);
1032 else
1033 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1034 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1036 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1039 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1043 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1044 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1045 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1047 static inline void
1048 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1050 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1054 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1055 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1056 pattern. */
1058 static inline void
1059 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1061 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1063 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1065 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1066 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1068 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1070 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1071 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1073 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1075 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1076 s->stippled_p = 0;
1078 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1080 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1081 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1083 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1084 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1086 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1087 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1089 else
1091 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1092 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1095 /* GC must have been set. */
1096 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1100 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1101 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1103 static inline void
1104 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1106 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1107 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1109 if (n > 0)
1110 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1111 s->num_clips = n;
1115 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1116 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1117 the area of SRC. */
1119 static void
1120 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1122 XRectangle r;
1124 r.x = src->x;
1125 r.width = src->width;
1126 r.y = src->y;
1127 r.height = src->height;
1128 dst->clip[0] = r;
1129 dst->num_clips = 1;
1130 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1134 /* RIF:
1135 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1137 static void
1138 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1140 if (s->cmp == NULL
1141 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1142 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1144 struct font_metrics metrics;
1146 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1148 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1149 struct font *font = s->font;
1150 int i;
1152 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1153 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1154 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1156 else
1158 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1160 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1162 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1163 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1164 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1166 else if (s->cmp)
1168 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1169 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1174 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1176 static inline void
1177 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1179 XGCValues xgcv;
1180 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1181 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1182 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1183 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1187 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1188 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1189 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1190 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1191 contains the first component of a composition. */
1193 static void
1194 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1196 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1197 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1198 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1200 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1202 if (s->stippled_p)
1204 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1205 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1206 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1207 s->y + box_line_width,
1208 s->background_width,
1209 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1210 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1211 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1213 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1214 || s->font_not_found_p
1215 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1216 || force_p)
1218 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1219 s->background_width,
1220 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1221 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1227 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1229 static void
1230 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1232 int i, x;
1234 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1235 of S to the right of that box line. */
1236 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1237 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1238 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1239 else
1240 x = s->x;
1242 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1243 loaded. */
1244 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1246 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1248 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1249 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1250 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1251 s->height - 1);
1252 x += g->pixel_width;
1255 else
1257 struct font *font = s->font;
1258 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1259 int y;
1261 if (font->vertical_centering)
1262 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1264 y = s->ybase - boff;
1265 if (s->for_overlaps
1266 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1267 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1268 else
1269 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1270 if (s->face->overstrike)
1271 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1275 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1277 static void
1278 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1280 int i, j, x;
1281 struct font *font = s->font;
1283 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1284 of S to the right of that box line. */
1285 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1286 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1287 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1288 else
1289 x = s->x;
1291 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1292 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1293 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1294 this composition. */
1296 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1297 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1298 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1300 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1301 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1302 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1304 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1306 int y = s->ybase;
1308 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1309 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1310 space on the left or right. */
1311 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1313 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1314 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1316 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1317 if (s->face->overstrike)
1318 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1321 else
1323 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1324 Lisp_Object glyph;
1325 int y = s->ybase;
1326 int width = 0;
1328 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1330 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1331 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1332 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1333 else
1335 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1337 if (j < i)
1339 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1340 if (s->face->overstrike)
1341 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1342 x += width;
1344 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1345 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1346 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1347 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1348 if (s->face->overstrike)
1349 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1350 x += wadjust;
1351 j = i + 1;
1352 width = 0;
1355 if (j < i)
1357 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1358 if (s->face->overstrike)
1359 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1365 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1367 static void
1368 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1370 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1371 XChar2b char2b[8];
1372 int x, i, j;
1374 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1375 of S to the right of that box line. */
1376 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1377 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1378 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1379 else
1380 x = s->x;
1382 s->char2b = char2b;
1384 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1386 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1387 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1389 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1391 if (len > 0
1392 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1393 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1394 >= 1))
1396 Lisp_Object acronym
1397 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1398 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1399 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1400 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1401 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1402 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1405 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1407 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1408 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1409 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1410 str = buf;
1413 if (str)
1415 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1416 unsigned code;
1418 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1419 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1421 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1422 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1424 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1425 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1426 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1428 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1429 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1430 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1433 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1434 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1435 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1436 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1437 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1438 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1442 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1444 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1445 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1446 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1447 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1448 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1451 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1452 cannot be determined. */
1454 static struct frame *
1455 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1457 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1458 Lisp_Object tail;
1459 struct frame *f;
1461 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1463 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1464 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1465 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1466 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1467 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1468 widget = XtParent (widget);
1470 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1471 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1472 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1473 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1474 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1475 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1476 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1477 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1478 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1479 return f;
1481 abort ();
1485 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1487 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1488 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1489 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1490 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1491 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1492 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1495 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1496 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1498 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1499 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1502 #endif
1505 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1506 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1508 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1510 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1511 sizeof (Screen *)},
1512 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1513 sizeof (Colormap)}
1517 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1518 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1520 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1523 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1525 DPY is the display we are working on.
1527 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1528 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1529 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1530 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1532 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1533 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1535 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1536 we allocated the color or not.
1538 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1540 static Boolean
1541 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1542 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1543 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1545 Screen *screen;
1546 Colormap cmap;
1547 Pixel pixel;
1548 String color_name;
1549 XColor color;
1551 if (*nargs != 2)
1553 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1554 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1555 "XtToolkitError",
1556 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1557 return False;
1560 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1561 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1562 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1564 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1566 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1567 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1569 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1571 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1572 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1574 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1575 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1577 pixel = color.pixel;
1578 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1580 else
1582 String params[1];
1583 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1585 params[0] = color_name;
1586 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1587 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1588 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1589 params, &nparams);
1590 return False;
1593 if (to->addr != NULL)
1595 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1597 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1598 return False;
1601 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1603 else
1605 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1606 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1609 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1610 return True;
1614 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1615 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1616 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1618 APP is the application context in which we work.
1620 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1621 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1622 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1624 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1626 static void
1627 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1628 Cardinal *nargs)
1630 if (*nargs != 2)
1632 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1633 "XtToolkitError",
1634 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1635 NULL, NULL);
1637 else if (closure != NULL)
1639 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1640 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1641 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1642 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1643 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1648 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1651 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1652 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1653 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1654 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1656 static const XColor *
1657 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1659 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1661 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1663 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1664 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1665 int i;
1667 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1668 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1669 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1671 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1672 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1674 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1675 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1678 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1679 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1683 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1684 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1686 void
1687 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1689 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1691 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1693 int i;
1694 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1696 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1697 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1698 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1699 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1702 else
1703 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1707 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1708 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1710 void
1711 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1713 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1717 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1718 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1719 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1720 allocated. */
1722 static int
1723 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1725 int rc;
1727 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1728 if (rc == 0)
1730 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1731 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1732 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1733 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1734 int nearest, i;
1735 int max_color_delta = 255;
1736 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1737 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1738 int ncells;
1739 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1741 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1743 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1744 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1745 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1746 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1748 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1750 nearest = i;
1751 nearest_delta = delta;
1755 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1756 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1757 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1758 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1760 else
1762 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1763 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1764 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1765 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1766 XColor *cached_color;
1768 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1769 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1770 (cached_color->red != color->red
1771 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1772 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1774 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1775 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1776 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1780 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1781 if (rc)
1782 register_color (color->pixel);
1783 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1785 return rc;
1789 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1790 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1791 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1792 allocated. */
1795 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1797 gamma_correct (f, color);
1798 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1802 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1803 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1804 get color reference counts right. */
1806 unsigned long
1807 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1809 XColor color;
1811 color.pixel = pixel;
1812 BLOCK_INPUT;
1813 x_query_color (f, &color);
1814 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1815 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1816 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1817 register_color (pixel);
1818 #endif
1819 return color.pixel;
1823 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1824 boosted.
1826 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1827 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1828 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1829 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1830 use an additional additive factor.
1832 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1833 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1834 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1837 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1838 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1839 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1840 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1841 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1842 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1844 static int
1845 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1847 XColor color, new;
1848 long bright;
1849 int success_p;
1851 /* Get RGB color values. */
1852 color.pixel = *pixel;
1853 x_query_color (f, &color);
1855 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1856 xassert (factor >= 0);
1857 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1858 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1859 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1861 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1862 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1864 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1865 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1866 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1867 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1868 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1870 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1871 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1872 /* The additive adjustment. */
1873 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1875 if (factor < 1)
1877 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1878 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1879 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1881 else
1883 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1884 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1885 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1889 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1890 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1891 if (success_p)
1893 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1895 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1896 delta to the RGB values. */
1897 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1899 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1900 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1901 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1902 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1904 else
1905 success_p = 1;
1906 *pixel = new.pixel;
1909 return success_p;
1913 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1914 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1915 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1916 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1917 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1918 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1920 static void
1921 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1923 XGCValues xgcv;
1924 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1925 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1926 unsigned long pixel;
1927 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1928 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1929 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1930 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1932 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1933 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1935 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1936 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1937 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1938 if (relief->gc
1939 && relief->allocated_p)
1941 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1942 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1945 /* Allocate new color. */
1946 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1947 pixel = background;
1948 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1949 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1951 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1952 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1955 if (relief->gc == 0)
1957 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1958 mask |= GCStipple;
1959 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1961 else
1962 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1966 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1968 static void
1969 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1971 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1972 unsigned long color;
1974 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1975 color = s->face->box_color;
1976 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1977 && s->img->pixmap
1978 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1979 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1980 else
1982 XGCValues xgcv;
1984 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1985 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1986 color = xgcv.background;
1989 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1990 || color != di->relief_background)
1992 di->relief_background = color;
1993 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1994 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1995 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1996 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2001 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2002 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2003 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2004 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2005 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2006 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2007 when drawing. */
2009 static void
2010 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
2011 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2012 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
2013 XRectangle *clip_rect)
2015 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2016 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2017 int i;
2018 GC gc;
2020 if (raised_p)
2021 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2022 else
2023 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2024 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2026 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2027 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2028 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2029 corner pixels. */
2031 /* Top. */
2032 if (top_p)
2034 if (width == 1)
2035 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2036 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2037 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2039 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2040 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2041 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2042 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2045 /* Left. */
2046 if (left_p)
2048 if (width == 1)
2049 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2051 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2052 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2054 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2055 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2056 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2059 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2060 if (raised_p)
2061 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2062 else
2063 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2064 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2066 if (width > 1)
2068 /* Outermost top line. */
2069 if (top_p)
2070 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2071 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2072 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2074 /* Outermost left line. */
2075 if (left_p)
2076 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2079 /* Bottom. */
2080 if (bot_p)
2082 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2083 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2084 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2085 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2086 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2087 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2088 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2091 /* Right. */
2092 if (right_p)
2094 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2095 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2096 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2097 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2098 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2101 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2105 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2106 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2107 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2108 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2109 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2110 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2112 static void
2113 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2114 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2115 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2117 XGCValues xgcv;
2119 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2120 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2121 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2123 /* Top. */
2124 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2125 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2127 /* Left. */
2128 if (left_p)
2129 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2130 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2132 /* Bottom. */
2133 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2134 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2136 /* Right. */
2137 if (right_p)
2138 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2139 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2141 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2142 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2146 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2148 static void
2149 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2151 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2152 int left_p, right_p;
2153 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2154 XRectangle clip_rect;
2156 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2157 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2158 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2160 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2161 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2162 ? s->first_glyph
2163 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2165 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2166 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2167 left_x = s->x;
2168 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2169 ? last_x - 1
2170 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2171 top_y = s->y;
2172 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2174 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2175 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2176 && (s->prev == NULL
2177 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2178 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2179 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2180 && (s->next == NULL
2181 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2183 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2185 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2186 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2187 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2188 else
2190 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2191 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2192 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2197 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2199 static void
2200 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2202 int x = s->x;
2203 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2205 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2206 right of that line. */
2207 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2208 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2209 && s->slice.x == 0)
2210 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2212 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2213 by that margin. */
2214 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2215 x += s->img->hmargin;
2216 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2217 y += s->img->vmargin;
2219 if (s->img->pixmap)
2221 if (s->img->mask)
2223 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2224 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2225 trust on the shape extension to be available
2226 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2227 manually. */
2228 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2229 | GCFunction);
2230 XGCValues xgcv;
2231 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2233 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2234 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2235 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2236 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2237 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2239 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2240 image_rect.x = x;
2241 image_rect.y = y;
2242 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2243 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2244 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2245 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2246 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2247 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2249 else
2251 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2253 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2254 image_rect.x = x;
2255 image_rect.y = y;
2256 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2257 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2258 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2259 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2260 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2261 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2263 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2264 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2265 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2266 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2267 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2268 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2269 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2271 int relief = s->img->relief;
2272 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2273 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2274 x - relief, y - relief,
2275 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2276 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2280 else
2281 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2282 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2283 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2287 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2289 static void
2290 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2292 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, extra;
2293 XRectangle r;
2294 int x = s->x;
2295 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2297 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2298 right of that line. */
2299 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2300 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2301 && s->slice.x == 0)
2302 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2304 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2305 by that margin. */
2306 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2307 x += s->img->hmargin;
2308 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2309 y += s->img->vmargin;
2311 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2312 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2314 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2315 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2317 else
2319 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2320 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2323 extra = s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2324 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) : 0;
2326 x0 = x - thick - extra;
2327 y0 = y - thick - extra;
2328 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra;
2329 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra;
2331 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2332 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2333 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2334 s->slice.y == 0,
2335 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2336 s->slice.x == 0,
2337 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2338 &r);
2342 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2344 static void
2345 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2347 int x = 0;
2348 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2350 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2351 right of that line. */
2352 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2353 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2354 && s->slice.x == 0)
2355 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2357 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2358 by that margin. */
2359 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2360 x += s->img->hmargin;
2361 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2362 y += s->img->vmargin;
2364 if (s->img->pixmap)
2366 if (s->img->mask)
2368 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2369 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2370 trust on the shape extension to be available
2371 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2372 manually. */
2373 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2374 | GCFunction);
2375 XGCValues xgcv;
2377 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2378 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2379 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2380 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2381 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2383 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2384 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2385 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2386 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2388 else
2390 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2391 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2392 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2394 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2395 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2396 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2397 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2398 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2399 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2400 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2402 int r = s->img->relief;
2403 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2404 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2405 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2406 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2410 else
2411 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2412 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2413 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2417 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2418 give the rectangle to draw. */
2420 static void
2421 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2423 if (s->stippled_p)
2425 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2426 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2427 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2428 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2430 else
2431 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2435 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2437 s->y
2438 s->x +-------------------------
2439 | s->face->box
2441 | +-------------------------
2442 | | s->img->margin
2444 | | +-------------------
2445 | | | the image
2449 static void
2450 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2452 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2453 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2454 int height;
2455 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2457 height = s->height;
2458 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2459 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2460 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2461 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2463 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2464 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2465 flickering. */
2466 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2467 if (height > s->slice.height
2468 || s->img->hmargin
2469 || s->img->vmargin
2470 || s->img->mask
2471 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2472 || s->width != s->background_width)
2474 if (s->img->mask)
2476 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2477 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2478 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2479 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2480 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2482 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2483 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2484 s->background_width,
2485 s->height, depth);
2487 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2488 pixmap. */
2489 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2491 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2492 if (s->stippled_p)
2494 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2495 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2496 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2497 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2498 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2499 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2500 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2502 else
2504 XGCValues xgcv;
2505 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2506 &xgcv);
2507 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2508 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2509 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2510 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2513 else
2515 int x = s->x;
2516 int y = s->y;
2518 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2519 && s->slice.x == 0)
2520 x += box_line_hwidth;
2522 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2523 y += box_line_vwidth;
2525 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2528 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2531 /* Draw the foreground. */
2532 if (pixmap != None)
2534 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2535 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2536 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2537 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2538 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2540 else
2541 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2543 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2544 if (s->img->relief
2545 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2546 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2547 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2551 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2553 static void
2554 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2556 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2558 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2559 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2561 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2562 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2563 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2564 int x = s->x;
2566 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2568 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2570 if (x < left_x)
2572 background_width -= left_x - x;
2573 x = left_x;
2576 else
2578 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2579 stretch glyph. */
2580 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2582 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2583 background_width -= x - right_x;
2584 x += background_width;
2586 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2587 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2588 x -= width;
2590 /* Draw cursor. */
2591 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2593 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2594 if (width < background_width)
2596 int y = s->y;
2597 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2598 XRectangle r;
2599 GC gc;
2601 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2602 x += width;
2603 else
2604 x = s->x;
2605 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2606 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2608 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2609 gc = s->gc;
2611 else
2612 gc = s->face->gc;
2614 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2615 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2617 if (s->face->stipple)
2619 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2620 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2621 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2622 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2624 else
2626 XGCValues xgcv;
2627 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2628 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2629 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2630 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2634 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2636 int background_width = s->background_width;
2637 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2639 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2640 except for header line and mode line. */
2641 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2643 background_width -= left_x - x;
2644 x = left_x;
2646 if (background_width > 0)
2647 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2650 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2654 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2656 static void
2657 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2659 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2661 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2662 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2663 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2664 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2666 int width;
2667 struct glyph_string *next;
2669 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2670 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2671 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2672 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2674 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2675 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2676 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2677 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2678 else
2679 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2680 next->num_clips = 0;
2684 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2685 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2687 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2688 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2689 if (!s->for_overlaps
2690 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2691 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2692 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2695 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2696 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2697 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2698 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2699 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2701 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2702 && !s->clip_tail
2703 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2704 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2705 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2706 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2707 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2708 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2709 else
2710 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2712 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2714 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2715 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2716 break;
2718 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2719 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2720 break;
2722 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2723 if (s->for_overlaps)
2724 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2725 else
2726 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2727 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2728 break;
2730 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2731 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2732 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2733 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2734 else
2735 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2736 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2737 break;
2739 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2740 if (s->for_overlaps)
2741 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2742 else
2743 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2744 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2745 break;
2747 default:
2748 abort ();
2751 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2753 /* Draw underline. */
2754 if (s->face->underline_p)
2756 unsigned long thickness, position;
2757 int y;
2759 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2761 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2762 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2763 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2765 else
2767 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2768 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2769 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2770 else
2771 thickness = 1;
2772 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2773 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2774 else
2776 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2777 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2778 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2779 specs, and its default is
2781 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2782 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2784 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2785 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2786 position = s->font->underline_position;
2787 else if (s->font)
2788 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2789 else
2790 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2792 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2794 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2795 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2796 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2797 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2798 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2799 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2800 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2801 s->underline_position = position;
2802 y = s->ybase + position;
2803 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2804 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2805 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2806 else
2808 XGCValues xgcv;
2809 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2810 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2811 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2812 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2813 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2817 /* Draw overline. */
2818 if (s->face->overline_p)
2820 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2822 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2823 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2824 s->width, h);
2825 else
2827 XGCValues xgcv;
2828 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2829 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2830 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2831 s->width, h);
2832 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2836 /* Draw strike-through. */
2837 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2839 unsigned long h = 1;
2840 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2842 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2843 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2844 s->width, h);
2845 else
2847 XGCValues xgcv;
2848 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2849 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2850 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2851 s->width, h);
2852 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2856 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2857 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2858 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2860 if (s->prev)
2862 struct glyph_string *prev;
2864 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2865 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2866 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2868 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2869 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2870 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2872 prev->hl = s->hl;
2873 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2874 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2875 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2876 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2877 else
2878 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2879 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2880 prev->hl = save;
2881 prev->num_clips = 0;
2885 if (s->next)
2887 struct glyph_string *next;
2889 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2890 if (next->hl != s->hl
2891 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2893 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2894 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2895 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2897 next->hl = s->hl;
2898 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2899 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2900 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2901 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2902 else
2903 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2904 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2905 next->hl = save;
2906 next->num_clips = 0;
2911 /* Reset clipping. */
2912 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2913 s->num_clips = 0;
2916 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2918 static void
2919 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2921 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2922 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2923 x, y, width, height,
2924 x + shift_by, y);
2927 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2928 for X frames. */
2930 static void
2931 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2933 abort ();
2937 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2938 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2940 void
2941 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2943 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2944 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2948 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2950 static void
2951 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2953 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2954 longer visible. */
2955 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2956 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2957 output_cursor.x = -1;
2959 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2960 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2961 BLOCK_INPUT;
2963 /* The following call is commented out because it does not seem to accomplish
2964 anything, apart from causing flickering during window resize. */
2965 /* XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f)); */
2967 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
2968 something like that, then they should be notified. */
2969 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2971 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2972 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2973 redisplay, do it here. */
2974 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2975 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2976 #endif
2978 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2980 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2985 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2987 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2988 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2990 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2993 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2994 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2996 static int
2997 timeval_subtract (struct timeval *result, struct timeval x, struct timeval y)
2999 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
3000 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
3001 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
3003 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
3004 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
3005 y.tv_sec += nsec;
3008 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
3010 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
3011 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
3012 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
3015 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
3016 positive. */
3017 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
3018 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
3020 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
3021 negative. */
3022 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
3025 static void
3026 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3028 BLOCK_INPUT;
3031 #ifdef USE_GTK
3032 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3033 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3034 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3035 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3036 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3037 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3038 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3039 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3040 do { \
3041 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3042 cairo_fill (cr); \
3044 while (0)
3045 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3046 GdkGCValues vals;
3047 GdkGC *gc;
3048 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3049 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3050 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3051 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3052 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3053 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3054 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3055 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3056 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3057 GC gc;
3059 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3060 pixels into background pixels. */
3062 XGCValues values;
3064 values.function = GXxor;
3065 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3066 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3068 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3069 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3071 #endif
3073 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3074 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3075 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3076 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3077 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3078 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3079 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3081 int width;
3083 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3084 edge it is next to. */
3085 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3087 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3088 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3089 break;
3091 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3092 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3093 break;
3095 default:
3096 break;
3099 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3101 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3102 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3104 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3105 flash_left,
3106 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3107 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3108 width, flash_height);
3109 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3110 flash_left,
3111 (height - flash_height
3112 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3113 width, flash_height);
3116 else
3117 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3118 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3119 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3120 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3122 x_flush (f);
3125 struct timeval wakeup;
3127 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3129 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3130 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3131 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3132 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3134 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3135 available. */
3136 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3138 struct timeval current;
3139 struct timeval timeout;
3141 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3143 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3144 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3145 break;
3147 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3148 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3149 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3151 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3152 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3156 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3157 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3159 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3160 flash_left,
3161 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3162 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3163 width, flash_height);
3164 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3165 flash_left,
3166 (height - flash_height
3167 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3168 width, flash_height);
3170 else
3171 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3172 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3173 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3174 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3176 #ifdef USE_GTK
3177 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3178 cairo_destroy (cr);
3179 #else
3180 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3181 #endif
3182 #undef XFillRectangle
3183 #else
3184 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3185 #endif
3186 x_flush (f);
3190 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3193 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3196 static void
3197 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3199 BLOCK_INPUT;
3200 if (invisible)
3202 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3203 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3204 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3206 else
3207 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3208 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3209 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3210 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3214 /* Make audible bell. */
3216 static void
3217 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3219 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3221 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3222 if (visible_bell)
3223 XTflash (f);
3224 else
3225 #endif
3227 BLOCK_INPUT;
3228 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3229 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3230 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3236 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3237 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3238 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3239 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3241 static void
3242 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3244 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3249 /***********************************************************************
3250 Line Dance
3251 ***********************************************************************/
3253 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3254 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3256 static void
3257 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3259 abort ();
3263 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3265 static void
3266 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3268 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3269 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3271 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3272 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3273 fringe of W. */
3274 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3276 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3277 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3278 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3279 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3280 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3281 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3282 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3283 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3285 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3287 if (sb_width > 0)
3289 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3290 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3291 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3293 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3295 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3296 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3298 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3299 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3302 #endif
3304 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3305 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3306 bottom_y = y + height;
3308 if (to_y < from_y)
3310 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3311 line at the bottom. */
3312 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3313 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3314 else
3315 height = run->height;
3317 else
3319 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3320 at the bottom. */
3321 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3322 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3323 else
3324 height = run->height;
3327 BLOCK_INPUT;
3329 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3330 updated_window = w;
3331 x_clear_cursor (w);
3333 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3334 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3335 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3336 x, from_y,
3337 width, height,
3338 x, to_y);
3340 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3345 /***********************************************************************
3346 Exposure Events
3347 ***********************************************************************/
3350 static void
3351 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3353 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3354 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3355 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3356 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3357 BLOCK_INPUT;
3358 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3359 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3360 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3361 because of this (bug#9310). */
3362 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3363 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3364 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3365 x_uncatch_errors ();
3366 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3367 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3368 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3371 static void
3372 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3374 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3375 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3376 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3377 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3378 BLOCK_INPUT;
3379 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3380 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3381 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3382 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3383 x_uncatch_errors ();
3384 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3385 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3386 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3389 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3390 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3391 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3392 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3393 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3395 static void
3396 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3398 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3400 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3402 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3403 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3404 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3406 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3407 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3409 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3410 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3411 else
3412 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3415 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3418 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3419 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3420 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3422 static void
3423 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3425 if (type == FocusIn)
3427 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3429 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3430 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3432 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3433 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3434 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3435 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3436 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3438 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3439 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3443 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3445 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3446 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3447 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3448 #endif
3450 else if (type == FocusOut)
3452 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3454 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3456 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3457 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3460 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3461 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3462 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3463 #endif
3464 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3465 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3469 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3470 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3472 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3474 static void
3475 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3477 struct frame *frame;
3479 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3480 if (! frame)
3481 return;
3483 switch (event->type)
3485 case EnterNotify:
3486 case LeaveNotify:
3488 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3489 int focus_state
3490 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3492 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3493 && event->xcrossing.focus
3494 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3495 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3496 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3497 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3499 break;
3501 case FocusIn:
3502 case FocusOut:
3503 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3504 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3505 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3506 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3507 break;
3509 case ClientMessage:
3510 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3512 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3513 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3514 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3516 break;
3521 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3522 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3524 void
3525 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3527 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3529 #endif
3531 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3532 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3533 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3535 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3536 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3537 the appropriate X display info. */
3539 static void
3540 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3542 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3545 static void
3546 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3548 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3550 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3552 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3553 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3554 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3555 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3556 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3558 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3559 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3562 else
3563 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3565 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3567 if (old_highlight)
3568 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3569 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3570 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3576 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3578 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3579 static void
3580 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3582 int min_code, max_code;
3583 KeySym *syms;
3584 int syms_per_code;
3585 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3587 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3588 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3589 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3590 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3591 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3593 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3595 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3596 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3597 &syms_per_code);
3598 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3600 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3601 Alt keysyms are on. */
3603 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3604 int found_alt_or_meta;
3606 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3608 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3609 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3611 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3613 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3614 if (code == 0)
3615 continue;
3617 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3619 int code_col;
3621 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3623 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3625 switch (sym)
3627 case XK_Meta_L:
3628 case XK_Meta_R:
3629 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3630 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3631 break;
3633 case XK_Alt_L:
3634 case XK_Alt_R:
3635 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3636 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3637 break;
3639 case XK_Hyper_L:
3640 case XK_Hyper_R:
3641 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3642 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3643 code_col = syms_per_code;
3644 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3645 break;
3647 case XK_Super_L:
3648 case XK_Super_R:
3649 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3650 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3651 code_col = syms_per_code;
3652 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3653 break;
3655 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3656 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3657 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3658 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3659 code_col = syms_per_code;
3660 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3661 break;
3669 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3670 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3672 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3673 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3676 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3677 make them just meta, not alt. */
3678 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3680 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3683 XFree ((char *) syms);
3684 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3687 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3688 Emacs uses. */
3690 EMACS_INT
3691 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3693 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3694 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3695 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3696 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3697 Lisp_Object tem;
3699 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3700 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3701 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3702 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3703 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3704 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3705 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3706 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3709 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3710 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3711 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3712 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3713 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3714 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3717 static int
3718 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3720 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3721 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3722 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3723 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3725 Lisp_Object tem;
3727 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3728 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3729 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3730 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3731 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3732 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3733 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3734 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3737 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3738 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3739 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3740 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3741 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3742 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3745 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3747 char *
3748 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3750 char *value;
3752 BLOCK_INPUT;
3753 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3754 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3756 return value;
3761 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3763 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3765 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3766 the mouse. */
3768 static Lisp_Object
3769 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3771 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3772 otherwise. */
3773 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3774 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3775 result->timestamp = event->time;
3776 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3777 event->state)
3778 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3779 ? up_modifier
3780 : down_modifier));
3782 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3783 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3784 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3785 result->arg = Qnil;
3786 return Qnil;
3790 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3791 The input handler calls this.
3793 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3794 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3795 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3796 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3798 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3799 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3801 static int
3802 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3804 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3805 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3806 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3808 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3809 return 0;
3811 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3813 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3814 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3815 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3816 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3817 return 1;
3821 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3822 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3823 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3824 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3825 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3826 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3828 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3829 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3830 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3831 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3832 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3833 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3834 return 1;
3837 return 0;
3841 /************************************************************************
3842 Mouse Face
3843 ************************************************************************/
3845 static void
3846 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3848 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3849 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3850 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3851 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3852 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3857 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3858 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3860 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3861 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3862 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3863 position on the scroll bar.
3865 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3866 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3867 the mouse is over.
3869 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3870 was at this position.
3872 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3874 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3875 movement. */
3877 static void
3878 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3879 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3880 Time *timestamp)
3882 FRAME_PTR f1;
3884 BLOCK_INPUT;
3886 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3887 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3888 else
3890 Window root;
3891 int root_x, root_y;
3893 Window dummy_window;
3894 int dummy;
3896 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3898 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3899 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3900 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3901 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3902 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3904 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3906 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3907 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3908 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3910 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3911 &root,
3913 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3914 a different screen. */
3915 &dummy_window,
3917 /* The position on that root window. */
3918 &root_x, &root_y,
3920 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3921 &dummy, &dummy,
3923 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3924 we don't care. */
3925 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3927 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3928 containing the pointer. */
3930 Window win, child;
3931 int win_x, win_y;
3932 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3934 win = root;
3936 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3937 structure is changing at the same time this function
3938 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3940 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3942 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3943 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3945 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3946 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3947 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3949 /* From-window, to-window. */
3950 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3952 /* From-position, to-position. */
3953 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3955 /* Child of win. */
3956 &child);
3957 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3959 else
3961 while (1)
3963 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3965 /* From-window, to-window. */
3966 root, win,
3968 /* From-position, to-position. */
3969 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3971 /* Child of win. */
3972 &child);
3974 if (child == None || child == win)
3975 break;
3976 #ifdef USE_GTK
3977 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3978 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3979 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3980 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3981 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3982 break;
3983 #endif
3984 win = child;
3985 parent_x = win_x;
3986 parent_y = win_y;
3989 /* Now we know that:
3990 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3991 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3992 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3993 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3994 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3995 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3996 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3997 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3998 never use them in that case.) */
4000 #ifdef USE_GTK
4001 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4002 want the edit window. */
4003 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4004 #else
4005 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4006 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4007 #endif
4009 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4010 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4011 on the frame. */
4012 if (f1 != NULL
4013 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4014 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4015 f1 = NULL;
4016 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4019 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4020 f1 = 0;
4022 x_uncatch_errors ();
4024 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4025 if (! f1)
4027 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4029 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4031 if (bar)
4033 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4034 win_x = parent_x;
4035 win_y = parent_y;
4039 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4040 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4042 if (f1)
4044 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4045 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4046 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4047 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4048 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4049 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4050 the frame are divided into. */
4052 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4053 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4055 *bar_window = Qnil;
4056 *part = 0;
4057 *fp = f1;
4058 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4059 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4060 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4065 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4070 /***********************************************************************
4071 Scroll bars
4072 ***********************************************************************/
4074 /* Scroll bar support. */
4076 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4077 manages it.
4078 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4079 bits. */
4081 static struct scroll_bar *
4082 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4084 Lisp_Object tail;
4086 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4087 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4088 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4090 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4092 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4094 frame = XCAR (tail);
4095 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4096 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4097 abort ();
4099 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4100 continue;
4102 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4103 right window ID. */
4104 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4105 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4106 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4107 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4108 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4109 condemned = Qnil,
4110 ! NILP (bar));
4111 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4112 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4113 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4114 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4117 return NULL;
4121 #if defined USE_LUCID
4123 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4124 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4126 static Widget
4127 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4129 Lisp_Object tail;
4131 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4133 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4135 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4136 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4138 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4139 return menu_bar;
4143 return NULL;
4146 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4149 /************************************************************************
4150 Toolkit scroll bars
4151 ************************************************************************/
4153 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4155 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4156 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4157 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4158 struct scroll_bar *);
4159 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4160 int, int, int);
4163 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4164 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4166 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4168 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4170 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4172 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4173 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4175 #ifndef USE_GTK
4176 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4178 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4180 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4182 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4183 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4184 to avoid jerkyness. */
4186 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4188 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4189 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4190 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4191 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4193 static void
4194 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4195 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4197 int scroll_bar_p;
4198 const char *end_action;
4200 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4201 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4202 end_action = "Release";
4203 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4204 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4205 end_action = "EndScroll";
4206 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4208 if (scroll_bar_p
4209 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4210 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4212 struct window *w;
4214 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4215 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4216 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4218 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4220 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4221 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4222 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4224 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4225 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4227 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4228 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4231 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4233 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4234 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4236 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4237 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4240 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4241 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4242 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4243 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4245 static void
4246 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4248 XEvent event;
4249 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4250 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4251 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4252 ptrdiff_t i;
4254 BLOCK_INPUT;
4256 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4257 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4258 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4259 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4260 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4261 ev->format = 32;
4263 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4264 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4265 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4266 into that array in the event. */
4267 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4268 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4269 break;
4271 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4273 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4274 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4275 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4276 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4277 scroll_bar_windows =
4278 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4279 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4280 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4281 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4284 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4285 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4286 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4287 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4288 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4289 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4291 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4292 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4293 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4294 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4295 #endif
4297 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4298 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4299 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4300 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4301 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4305 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4306 in *IEVENT. */
4308 static void
4309 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4311 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4312 Lisp_Object window;
4313 struct window *w;
4315 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4316 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4318 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4320 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4321 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4322 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4323 #ifdef USE_GTK
4324 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4325 #else
4326 ievent->timestamp =
4327 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4328 #endif
4329 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4330 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4331 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4332 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4333 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4337 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4339 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4341 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4344 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4345 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4346 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4348 static void
4349 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4351 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4352 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4353 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4355 switch (cs->reason)
4357 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4358 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4359 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4360 break;
4362 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4363 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4364 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4365 break;
4367 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4368 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4369 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4370 break;
4372 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4373 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4374 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4375 break;
4377 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4378 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4379 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4380 break;
4382 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4383 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4384 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4385 break;
4387 case XmCR_DRAG:
4389 int slider_size;
4391 /* Get the slider size. */
4392 BLOCK_INPUT;
4393 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4394 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4396 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4397 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4398 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4399 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4401 break;
4403 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4404 break;
4407 if (part >= 0)
4409 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4410 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4411 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4415 #elif defined USE_GTK
4417 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4418 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4420 static gboolean
4421 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4422 GtkScrollType scroll,
4423 gdouble value,
4424 gpointer user_data)
4426 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4427 gdouble position;
4428 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4429 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4430 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4432 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4433 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4436 switch (scroll)
4438 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4439 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4440 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4441 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4443 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4444 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4445 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4446 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4447 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4449 break;
4450 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4451 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4452 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4453 break;
4454 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4455 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4456 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4457 break;
4458 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4459 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4460 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4461 break;
4462 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4463 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4464 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4465 break;
4468 if (part >= 0)
4470 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4471 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4472 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4475 return FALSE;
4478 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4480 static gboolean
4481 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4482 GdkEventButton *event,
4483 gpointer user_data)
4485 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4486 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4487 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4489 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4490 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4491 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4494 return FALSE;
4498 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4500 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4501 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4502 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4503 the thumb is. */
4505 static void
4506 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4508 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4509 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4510 float shown;
4511 int whole, portion, height;
4512 int part;
4514 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4515 BLOCK_INPUT;
4516 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4517 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4519 whole = 10000000;
4520 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4522 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4523 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4524 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4525 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4526 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4527 bottom). */
4528 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4529 else
4530 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4532 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4533 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4534 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4535 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4539 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4540 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4541 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4542 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4543 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4544 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4545 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4547 static void
4548 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4550 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4551 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4552 int position = (long) call_data;
4553 Dimension height;
4554 int part;
4556 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4557 BLOCK_INPUT;
4558 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4559 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4561 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4562 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4564 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4565 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4566 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4567 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4568 else
4569 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4571 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4572 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4573 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4574 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4577 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4579 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4581 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4582 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4584 #ifdef USE_GTK
4585 static void
4586 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4588 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4590 BLOCK_INPUT;
4591 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4592 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4593 scroll_bar_name);
4594 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4597 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4599 static void
4600 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4602 Window xwindow;
4603 Widget widget;
4604 Arg av[20];
4605 int ac = 0;
4606 char const *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4607 unsigned long pixel;
4609 BLOCK_INPUT;
4611 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4612 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4613 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4614 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4615 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4616 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4617 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4618 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4619 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4621 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4622 if (pixel != -1)
4624 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4625 ++ac;
4628 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4629 if (pixel != -1)
4631 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4632 ++ac;
4635 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4636 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4638 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4639 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4640 (XtPointer) bar);
4641 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4642 (XtPointer) bar);
4643 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4644 (XtPointer) bar);
4645 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4646 (XtPointer) bar);
4647 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4648 (XtPointer) bar);
4649 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4650 (XtPointer) bar);
4651 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4652 (XtPointer) bar);
4654 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4655 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4657 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4658 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4659 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4660 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4662 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4664 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4665 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4666 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4667 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4668 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4669 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4670 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4671 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4673 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4674 if (pixel != -1)
4676 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4677 ++ac;
4680 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4681 if (pixel != -1)
4683 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4684 ++ac;
4687 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4689 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4690 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4692 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4693 if (pixel != -1)
4695 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4696 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4697 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4698 pixel = -1;
4699 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4702 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4704 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4705 if (pixel != -1)
4707 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4708 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4709 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4710 pixel = -1;
4711 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4715 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4716 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4717 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4718 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4719 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4720 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4721 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4722 colors itself. */
4724 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4725 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4726 ++ac;
4728 else
4729 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4730 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4731 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4733 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4734 the shadows. */
4735 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4736 ++ac;
4738 /* Specify the colors. */
4739 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4740 if (pixel != -1)
4742 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4743 ++ac;
4745 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4746 if (pixel != -1)
4748 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4749 ++ac;
4752 #endif
4754 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4755 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4758 char const *initial = "";
4759 char const *val = initial;
4760 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4761 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4762 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4763 #endif
4764 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4765 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4766 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4767 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4768 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4769 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4773 /* Define callbacks. */
4774 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4775 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4776 (XtPointer) bar);
4778 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4779 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4781 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4783 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4784 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4785 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4786 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4788 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4789 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4790 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4791 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4793 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4795 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4798 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4799 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4801 #ifdef USE_GTK
4802 static void
4803 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4805 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4808 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4809 static void
4810 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4811 int whole)
4813 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4814 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4815 float top, shown;
4817 BLOCK_INPUT;
4819 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4821 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4822 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4823 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4824 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4825 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4826 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4827 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4828 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4829 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4830 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4831 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4832 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4833 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4834 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4835 whole += portion;
4837 if (whole <= 0)
4838 top = 0, shown = 1;
4839 else
4841 top = (float) position / whole;
4842 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4845 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4847 int size, value;
4849 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4850 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4851 value. */
4852 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4853 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4854 size = max (size, 1);
4856 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4857 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4858 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4860 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4862 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4864 if (whole == 0)
4865 top = 0, shown = 1;
4866 else
4868 top = (float) position / whole;
4869 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4873 float old_top, old_shown;
4874 Dimension height;
4875 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4876 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4877 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4878 XtNheight, &height,
4879 NULL);
4881 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4882 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4883 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4884 else
4885 top = old_top;
4886 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4887 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4889 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4890 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4891 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4892 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4894 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4895 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4896 else
4898 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4899 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4900 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4902 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4906 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4908 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4910 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4912 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4916 /************************************************************************
4917 Scroll bars, general
4918 ************************************************************************/
4920 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4921 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4922 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4923 scroll bar. */
4925 static struct scroll_bar *
4926 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4928 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4929 struct scroll_bar *bar
4930 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4932 BLOCK_INPUT;
4934 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4935 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4936 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4938 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4939 unsigned long mask;
4940 Window window;
4942 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4943 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4944 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4946 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4947 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4948 | ExposureMask);
4949 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4951 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4953 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4954 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4955 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4956 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4957 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4958 left, top, width,
4959 window_box_height (w), False);
4961 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4962 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4963 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4964 top,
4965 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4966 height,
4967 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4969 CopyFromParent,
4970 CopyFromParent,
4971 CopyFromParent,
4972 /* Attributes. */
4973 mask, &a);
4974 bar->x_window = window;
4976 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4978 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4979 bar->top = top;
4980 bar->left = left;
4981 bar->width = width;
4982 bar->height = height;
4983 bar->start = 0;
4984 bar->end = 0;
4985 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4986 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4988 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4989 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4990 bar->prev = Qnil;
4991 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4992 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4993 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4995 /* Map the window/widget. */
4996 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4998 #ifdef USE_GTK
4999 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5000 bar->x_window,
5001 top,
5002 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5003 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5004 max (height, 1));
5005 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5006 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5007 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5008 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5009 top,
5010 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5011 max (height, 1), 0);
5012 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5013 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5015 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5016 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5017 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5019 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5020 return bar;
5024 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5026 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5028 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5029 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5030 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5031 events.)
5033 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5034 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5035 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5036 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5037 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5039 static void
5040 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5042 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5043 Window w = bar->x_window;
5044 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5045 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5047 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5048 if (! rebuild
5049 && start == bar->start
5050 && end == bar->end)
5051 return;
5053 BLOCK_INPUT;
5056 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5057 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5058 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5060 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5061 the distance between start and end. */
5063 int length = end - start;
5065 if (start < 0)
5066 start = 0;
5067 else if (start > top_range)
5068 start = top_range;
5069 end = start + length;
5071 if (end < start)
5072 end = start;
5073 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5074 end = top_range;
5077 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5078 bar->start = start;
5079 bar->end = end;
5081 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5082 if (end > top_range)
5083 end = top_range;
5085 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5086 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5087 that many pixels tall. */
5088 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5090 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5091 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5092 if (0 < start)
5093 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5094 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5095 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5096 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5097 inside_width, start,
5098 False);
5100 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5101 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5102 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5103 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5105 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5106 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5107 /* x, y, width, height */
5108 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5109 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5110 inside_width, end - start);
5112 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5113 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5114 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5115 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5117 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5118 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5119 if (end < inside_height)
5120 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5121 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5122 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5123 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5124 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5125 False);
5129 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5132 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5134 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5135 nil. */
5137 static void
5138 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5140 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5141 BLOCK_INPUT;
5143 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5144 #ifdef USE_GTK
5145 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5146 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5147 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5148 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5149 #else
5150 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5151 #endif
5153 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5154 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5156 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5160 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5161 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5162 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5163 create one. */
5165 static void
5166 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5168 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5169 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5170 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5171 int window_y, window_height;
5172 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5173 int fringe_extended_p;
5174 #endif
5176 /* Get window dimensions. */
5177 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5178 top = window_y;
5179 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5180 height = window_height;
5182 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5183 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5185 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5186 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5187 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5188 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5189 else
5190 sb_width = width;
5192 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5193 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5194 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5195 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5196 else
5197 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5198 #else
5199 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5200 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5201 else
5202 sb_left = left;
5203 #endif
5205 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5206 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5207 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5208 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5209 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5210 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5211 else
5212 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5213 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5214 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5215 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5216 #endif
5218 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5219 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5221 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5223 BLOCK_INPUT;
5224 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5225 if (fringe_extended_p)
5226 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5227 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5228 else
5229 #endif
5230 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5231 left, top, width, height, False);
5232 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5235 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5237 else
5239 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5240 unsigned int mask = 0;
5242 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5244 BLOCK_INPUT;
5246 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5247 mask |= CWX;
5248 if (top != bar->top)
5249 mask |= CWY;
5250 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5251 mask |= CWWidth;
5252 if (height != bar->height)
5253 mask |= CWHeight;
5255 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5257 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5258 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5260 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5261 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5262 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5264 if (fringe_extended_p)
5265 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5266 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5267 else
5268 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5269 left, top, width, height, False);
5271 #ifdef USE_GTK
5272 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5273 bar->x_window,
5274 top,
5275 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5276 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5277 max (height, 1));
5278 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5279 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5280 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5281 top,
5282 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5283 max (height, 1), 0);
5284 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5286 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5288 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5289 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5290 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5292 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5293 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5294 height, False);
5295 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5296 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5297 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5298 height, False);
5301 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5302 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5303 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5304 example. */
5306 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5307 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5308 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5310 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5311 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5312 left + area_width - rest, top,
5313 rest, height, False);
5314 else
5315 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5316 left, top, rest, height, False);
5320 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5321 if (mask)
5323 XWindowChanges wc;
5325 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5326 wc.y = top;
5327 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5328 wc.height = height;
5329 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5330 mask, &wc);
5333 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5335 /* Remember new settings. */
5336 bar->left = sb_left;
5337 bar->top = top;
5338 bar->width = sb_width;
5339 bar->height = height;
5341 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5344 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5345 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5347 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5348 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5349 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5350 dragged. */
5351 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5353 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5355 if (whole == 0)
5356 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5357 else
5359 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5360 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5361 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5364 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5366 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5370 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5371 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5372 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5373 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5374 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5375 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5376 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5378 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5379 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5380 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5382 static void
5383 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5385 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5386 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5388 Lisp_Object bar;
5389 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5390 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5391 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5392 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5393 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5394 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5395 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5400 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5401 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5403 static void
5404 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5406 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5407 struct frame *f;
5409 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5410 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5411 abort ();
5413 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5415 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5416 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5417 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5419 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5420 the lists. */
5421 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5422 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5423 return;
5424 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5425 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5426 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5427 else
5428 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5429 one or the other! */
5430 abort ();
5432 else
5433 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5435 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5436 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5438 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5439 bar->prev = Qnil;
5440 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5441 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5442 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5445 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5446 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5448 static void
5449 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5451 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5453 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5455 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5456 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5457 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5459 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5461 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5463 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5465 next = b->next;
5466 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5469 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5470 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5474 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5475 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5476 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5478 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5479 mark bits. */
5481 static void
5482 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5484 Window w = bar->x_window;
5485 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5486 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5487 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5489 BLOCK_INPUT;
5491 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5493 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5494 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5495 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5496 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5498 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5499 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5501 /* x, y, width, height */
5502 0, 0,
5503 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5504 bar->height - 1);
5506 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5507 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5508 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5509 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5511 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5514 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5516 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5517 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5519 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5520 mark bits. */
5523 static void
5524 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5526 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5527 abort ();
5529 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5530 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5531 emacs_event->modifiers
5532 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5533 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5534 event->xbutton.state)
5535 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5536 ? up_modifier
5537 : down_modifier));
5538 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5539 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5540 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5542 int top_range
5543 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5544 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5546 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5547 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5549 if (y < bar->start)
5550 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5551 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5552 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5553 else
5554 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5556 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5557 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5558 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5559 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5561 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5562 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5564 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5565 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5567 #endif
5569 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5570 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5574 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5576 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5578 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5579 mark bits. */
5581 static void
5582 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5584 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5586 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5588 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5589 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5591 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5592 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5594 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5595 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5597 if (new_start != bar->start)
5599 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5601 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5606 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5608 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5609 on the scroll bar. */
5611 static void
5612 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5613 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5614 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5616 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5617 Window w = bar->x_window;
5618 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5619 int win_x, win_y;
5620 Window dummy_window;
5621 int dummy_coord;
5622 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5624 BLOCK_INPUT;
5626 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5627 report that. */
5628 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5630 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5631 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5632 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5634 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5635 &win_x, &win_y,
5637 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5638 &dummy_mask))
5640 else
5642 int top_range
5643 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5645 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5647 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5648 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5650 if (win_y < 0)
5651 win_y = 0;
5652 if (win_y > top_range)
5653 win_y = top_range;
5655 *fp = f;
5656 *bar_window = bar->window;
5658 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5659 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5660 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5661 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5662 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5663 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5664 else
5665 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5667 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5668 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5670 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5671 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5674 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5676 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5680 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5681 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5682 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5683 redraw them. */
5685 static void
5686 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5688 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5689 Lisp_Object bar;
5691 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5692 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5693 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5694 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5695 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5696 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5697 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5698 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5699 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5700 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5704 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5706 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5707 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5708 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5709 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5711 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5712 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5714 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5716 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5717 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5719 static int temp_index;
5720 static short temp_buffer[100];
5722 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5723 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5724 temp_index = 0; \
5725 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5727 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5728 on a particular display. */
5730 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5732 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5733 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5734 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5735 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5737 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5739 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5740 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5741 do \
5743 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5744 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5745 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5746 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5747 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5748 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5750 while (0)
5751 #endif
5753 enum
5755 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5756 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5757 X_EVENT_DROP
5760 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5761 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5762 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5764 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5765 this event further.
5766 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5768 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5769 static int
5770 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5772 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5773 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5774 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5775 was created. */
5777 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5778 event->xclient.window);
5780 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5782 #endif
5784 #ifdef USE_GTK
5785 static int current_count;
5786 static int current_finish;
5787 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5789 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5790 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5791 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5792 static GdkFilterReturn
5793 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5795 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5797 BLOCK_INPUT;
5798 if (current_count >= 0)
5800 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5802 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5804 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5805 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5806 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5807 so we do it here. */
5808 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5809 && dpyinfo
5810 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5812 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5813 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5815 #endif
5817 if (! dpyinfo)
5818 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5819 else
5820 current_count +=
5821 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5822 current_hold_quit);
5824 else
5825 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5827 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5829 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5830 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5832 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5834 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5837 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5838 enum xembed_message,
5839 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5841 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5843 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5844 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5845 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5847 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5849 static int
5850 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5851 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5853 union {
5854 struct input_event ie;
5855 struct selection_input_event sie;
5856 } inev;
5857 int count = 0;
5858 int do_help = 0;
5859 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5860 struct frame *f = NULL;
5861 struct coding_system coding;
5862 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5863 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5864 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5866 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5868 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5869 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5870 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5872 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5873 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5875 switch (event.type)
5877 case ClientMessage:
5879 if (event.xclient.message_type
5880 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5881 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5883 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5884 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5886 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5887 could be the shell widget window
5888 if the frame has no title bar. */
5889 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5890 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5891 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5892 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5893 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5894 #endif
5895 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5896 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5897 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5898 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5899 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5900 needed.
5902 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5903 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5904 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5905 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5906 Emacs. */
5908 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5909 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5910 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5911 if (f)
5913 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5914 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5915 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5916 x_catch_errors (d);
5917 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5918 /* The ICCCM says this is
5919 the only valid choice. */
5920 RevertToParent,
5921 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5922 /* This is needed to detect the error
5923 if there is an error. */
5924 XSync (d, False);
5925 x_uncatch_errors ();
5927 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5928 #endif /* 0 */
5929 goto done;
5932 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5933 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5935 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5936 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5937 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5938 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5939 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5940 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5941 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5942 session manager and one for this. */
5943 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5944 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5945 #endif
5947 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5948 event.xclient.window);
5949 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5950 for a single Emacs process. */
5951 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5952 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5953 event.xclient.window,
5954 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5955 else if (f)
5956 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5957 event.xclient.window,
5958 0, 0);
5960 goto done;
5963 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5964 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5966 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5967 event.xclient.window);
5968 if (!f)
5969 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5971 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5972 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5973 goto done;
5976 goto done;
5979 if (event.xclient.message_type
5980 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5982 goto done;
5985 if (event.xclient.message_type
5986 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5988 int new_x, new_y;
5989 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5991 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5992 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5994 if (f)
5996 f->left_pos = new_x;
5997 f->top_pos = new_y;
5999 goto done;
6002 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6003 if (event.xclient.message_type
6004 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6006 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6007 if (f)
6008 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6009 &event, NULL);
6010 goto done;
6012 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6014 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6015 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6016 || (event.xclient.message_type
6017 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6019 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6020 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6021 currently never do because we are interested in
6022 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6023 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6024 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6025 if (!f)
6026 goto OTHER;
6027 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6028 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6029 goto done;
6032 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6033 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6034 we construct an input_event. */
6035 if (event.xclient.message_type
6036 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6038 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6039 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6040 goto done;
6042 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6044 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6045 if (event.xclient.message_type
6046 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6048 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6049 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6050 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6052 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6053 goto done;
6056 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6058 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6059 if (!f)
6060 goto OTHER;
6061 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6062 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6064 break;
6066 case SelectionNotify:
6067 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6068 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6069 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6070 goto OTHER;
6071 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6072 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6073 break;
6075 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6076 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6077 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6078 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6079 goto OTHER;
6080 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6082 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6084 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6085 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6086 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6087 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6088 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6090 break;
6092 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6093 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6094 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6095 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6096 goto OTHER;
6097 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6099 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6101 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6102 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6103 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6104 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6105 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6106 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6107 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6108 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6110 break;
6112 case PropertyNotify:
6113 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6114 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6115 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6116 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty);
6118 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6119 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6120 goto OTHER;
6122 case ReparentNotify:
6123 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6124 if (f)
6126 int x, y;
6127 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6128 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6129 f->left_pos = x;
6130 f->top_pos = y;
6132 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6133 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6134 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6136 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6138 goto OTHER;
6140 case Expose:
6141 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6142 if (f)
6144 #ifdef USE_GTK
6145 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6146 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6147 event.xexpose.window,
6148 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6149 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6150 FALSE);
6151 #endif
6152 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6154 f->async_visible = 1;
6155 f->async_iconified = 0;
6156 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6157 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6159 else
6160 expose_frame (f,
6161 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6162 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6164 else
6166 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6167 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6168 #endif
6169 #if defined USE_LUCID
6170 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6171 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6172 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6174 Widget widget
6175 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6176 if (widget)
6177 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6179 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6181 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6182 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6183 goto OTHER;
6184 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6185 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6186 event.xexpose.window);
6188 if (bar)
6189 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6190 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6191 else
6192 goto OTHER;
6193 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6194 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6196 break;
6198 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6199 source area was obscured or not
6200 available. */
6201 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6202 if (f)
6204 expose_frame (f,
6205 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6206 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6207 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6209 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6210 else
6211 goto OTHER;
6212 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6213 break;
6215 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6216 source area was completely
6217 available. */
6218 break;
6220 case UnmapNotify:
6221 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6222 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6224 tip_window = 0;
6225 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6228 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6229 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6230 the frame was deleted. */
6232 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6233 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6234 display that won't ever be seen. */
6235 f->async_visible = 0;
6236 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6237 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6238 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6239 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6240 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6241 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6242 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6244 f->async_iconified = 1;
6246 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6247 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6250 goto OTHER;
6252 case MapNotify:
6253 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6254 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6255 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6256 goto OTHER;
6258 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6259 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6260 frame is visible. */
6261 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6262 if (f)
6264 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6265 the frame's display structures.
6266 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6267 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6268 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6269 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6270 if (! f->async_iconified)
6271 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6273 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6274 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6275 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6276 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6278 f->async_visible = 1;
6279 f->async_iconified = 0;
6280 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6282 if (f->iconified)
6284 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6285 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6287 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6288 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6289 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6290 to update the frame titles
6291 in case this is the second frame. */
6292 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6294 #ifdef USE_GTK
6295 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6296 #endif
6298 goto OTHER;
6300 case KeyPress:
6302 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6303 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6305 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6306 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6307 if (popup_activated ())
6308 goto OTHER;
6309 #endif
6311 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6313 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6314 mouse highlighting. */
6315 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6316 && (f == 0
6317 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6319 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6320 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6323 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6324 if (f == 0)
6326 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6327 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6328 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6329 event.xkey.window);
6330 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6332 widget = XtParent (widget);
6333 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6336 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6338 if (f != 0)
6340 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6341 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6342 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6343 his Emacs hang.
6345 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6346 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6347 status_return even if the input is too long to
6348 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6349 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6350 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6351 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6352 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6353 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6354 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6355 int modifiers;
6356 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6357 Lisp_Object c;
6359 #ifdef USE_GTK
6360 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6361 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6362 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6363 (see above). */
6364 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6365 #endif
6367 event.xkey.state
6368 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6369 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6370 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6372 /* This will have to go some day... */
6374 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6375 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6376 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6377 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6378 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6379 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6380 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6382 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6383 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6384 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6385 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6386 not it is combined with Meta. */
6387 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6388 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6390 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6391 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6393 Status status_return;
6395 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6396 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6397 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6398 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6399 &status_return);
6400 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6402 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6403 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6404 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6405 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6406 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6407 &status_return);
6409 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6410 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6411 break;
6412 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6414 keysym = NoSymbol;
6415 modifiers = 0;
6417 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6418 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6419 abort ();
6421 else
6422 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6423 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6424 &compose_status);
6425 #else
6426 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6427 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6428 &compose_status);
6429 #endif
6431 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6432 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6433 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6434 break;
6436 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6437 orig_keysym = keysym;
6439 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6440 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6441 inev.ie.modifiers
6442 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6443 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6445 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6446 translations to characters. */
6447 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6448 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6450 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6451 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6452 goto done_keysym;
6455 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6456 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6458 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6459 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6460 else
6461 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6462 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6463 goto done_keysym;
6466 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6467 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6468 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6469 Vx_keysym_table,
6470 Qnil))))
6472 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6473 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6474 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6475 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6476 goto done_keysym;
6479 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6480 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6481 || keysym == XK_Delete
6482 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6483 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6484 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6485 #endif
6486 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6487 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6488 #ifdef HPUX
6489 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6490 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6491 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6492 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6493 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6494 #endif
6495 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6496 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6497 #endif
6498 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6499 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6500 #endif
6501 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6502 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6503 #endif
6504 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6505 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6506 #endif
6507 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6508 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6509 #endif
6510 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6511 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6512 #endif
6513 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6514 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6515 #endif
6516 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6517 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6518 #endif
6519 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6520 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6521 #endif
6522 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6523 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6524 #endif
6525 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6526 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6527 #endif
6528 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6529 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6530 #endif
6531 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6532 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6533 #endif
6534 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6535 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6536 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6537 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6538 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6539 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6540 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6541 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6542 don't have real modifiers but
6543 should be treated similarly to
6544 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6545 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6546 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6547 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6548 #endif
6551 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6552 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6553 key. */
6554 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6555 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6556 goto done_keysym;
6559 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6560 ptrdiff_t i;
6561 int nchars, len;
6563 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6565 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6566 nchars++;
6567 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6570 if (nchars < nbytes)
6572 /* Decode the input data. */
6574 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6575 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6576 we used just above and the locale. */
6577 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6578 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6579 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6580 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6581 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6582 gives us composition information. */
6583 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6585 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6586 nbytes);
6587 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6588 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6589 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6590 nbytes = coding.produced;
6591 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6592 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6595 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6596 character events. */
6597 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6599 int ch;
6600 if (nchars == nbytes)
6601 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6602 else
6603 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6604 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6605 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6606 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6607 inev.ie.code = ch;
6608 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6611 count += nchars;
6613 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6615 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6616 break;
6619 done_keysym:
6620 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6621 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6622 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6623 client. */
6624 break;
6625 #else
6626 goto OTHER;
6627 #endif
6629 case KeyRelease:
6630 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6631 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6632 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6633 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6634 client. */
6635 break;
6636 #else
6637 goto OTHER;
6638 #endif
6640 case EnterNotify:
6641 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6642 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6644 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6646 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6647 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6649 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6650 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6651 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6652 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6653 #ifdef USE_GTK
6654 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6655 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6656 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6657 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6658 #endif
6659 goto OTHER;
6661 case FocusIn:
6662 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6663 goto OTHER;
6665 case LeaveNotify:
6666 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6667 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6669 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6670 if (f)
6672 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6674 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6675 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6676 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6677 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6680 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6681 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6682 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6683 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6684 if (any_help_event_p)
6685 do_help = -1;
6687 #ifdef USE_GTK
6688 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6689 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6690 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6691 #endif
6692 goto OTHER;
6694 case FocusOut:
6695 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6696 goto OTHER;
6698 case MotionNotify:
6700 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6701 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6702 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6704 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6705 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6706 f = last_mouse_frame;
6707 else
6708 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6710 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6712 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6713 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6716 #ifdef USE_GTK
6717 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6718 f = 0;
6719 #endif
6720 if (f)
6723 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6724 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6725 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6727 Lisp_Object window;
6729 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6730 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6731 0, 0);
6733 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6734 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6735 will be selected only when it is active. */
6736 if (WINDOWP (window)
6737 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6738 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6739 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6740 create event iff we don't leave the
6741 selected frame. */
6742 && (focus_follows_mouse
6743 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6744 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6746 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6747 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6750 last_window=window;
6752 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6753 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6755 else
6757 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6758 struct scroll_bar *bar
6759 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6760 event.xmotion.window);
6762 if (bar)
6763 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6764 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6766 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6767 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6768 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6771 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6772 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6773 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6774 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6775 do_help = 1;
6776 goto OTHER;
6779 case ConfigureNotify:
6780 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6781 #ifdef USE_GTK
6782 if (!f
6783 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6784 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6786 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6787 event.xconfigure.height);
6788 f = 0;
6790 #endif
6791 if (f)
6793 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6794 #ifndef USE_GTK
6795 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6796 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6798 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6799 is called by the code that handles resizing
6800 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6802 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6803 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6804 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6805 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6806 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6807 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6808 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6810 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6811 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6812 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6815 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6816 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6817 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6818 #endif
6820 #ifdef USE_GTK
6821 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6822 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6823 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6824 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6825 #endif
6827 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6830 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6831 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6832 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6833 #endif
6836 goto OTHER;
6838 case ButtonRelease:
6839 case ButtonPress:
6841 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6842 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6843 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6845 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6846 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6847 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6849 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6850 && last_mouse_frame
6851 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6852 f = last_mouse_frame;
6853 else
6854 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6856 #ifdef USE_GTK
6857 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6858 f = 0;
6859 #endif
6860 if (f)
6862 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6863 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6864 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6866 Lisp_Object window;
6867 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6868 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6870 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6871 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6873 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6875 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6876 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6877 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6878 event.xbutton.state));
6882 if (!tool_bar_p)
6883 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6884 if (! popup_activated ())
6885 #endif
6887 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6889 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6890 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6892 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6893 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6895 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6896 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6898 else
6899 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6901 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6902 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6903 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6905 else
6907 struct scroll_bar *bar
6908 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6909 event.xbutton.window);
6911 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6912 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6913 scroll bars. */
6914 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6916 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6917 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6919 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6920 if (bar)
6921 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6922 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6925 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6927 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6928 last_mouse_frame = f;
6930 if (!tool_bar_p)
6931 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6933 else
6934 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6936 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6937 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6938 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6939 if (f != 0)
6940 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6942 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6943 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6944 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6945 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6946 Instead, save it away
6947 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6948 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6949 if (! popup_activated ()
6950 #ifdef USE_GTK
6951 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6952 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6953 #endif
6954 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6955 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6956 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6957 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6958 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6959 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6960 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6961 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6963 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6964 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6965 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6967 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6969 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6970 goto OTHER;
6972 else
6973 goto OTHER;
6974 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6976 break;
6978 case CirculateNotify:
6979 goto OTHER;
6981 case CirculateRequest:
6982 goto OTHER;
6984 case VisibilityNotify:
6985 goto OTHER;
6987 case MappingNotify:
6988 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6989 local cache. */
6990 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6992 case MappingModifier:
6993 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6994 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6995 case MappingKeyboard:
6996 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6998 goto OTHER;
7000 case DestroyNotify:
7001 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7002 break;
7004 default:
7005 OTHER:
7006 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7007 BLOCK_INPUT;
7008 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7009 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7010 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7011 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7012 break;
7015 done:
7016 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7018 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7019 count++;
7022 if (do_help
7023 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7025 Lisp_Object frame;
7027 if (f)
7028 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7029 else
7030 frame = Qnil;
7032 if (do_help > 0)
7034 any_help_event_p = 1;
7035 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7036 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7038 else
7040 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7041 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7043 count++;
7046 SAFE_FREE ();
7047 *eventptr = event;
7048 return count;
7051 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7053 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7054 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7055 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7057 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7059 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7061 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7062 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7064 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7066 if (dpyinfo)
7067 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7069 return finish;
7071 #endif
7074 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7075 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7076 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7078 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7079 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7080 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7081 C chars).
7083 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7085 static int
7086 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7088 int count = 0;
7089 int event_found = 0;
7091 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7093 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7094 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7095 pending_signals = 1;
7096 #endif
7097 return -1;
7100 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7101 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7102 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7103 #endif
7104 BLOCK_INPUT;
7106 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7107 input_signal_count++;
7109 ++handling_signal;
7111 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7112 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7114 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7115 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7118 #ifndef USE_GTK
7119 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7121 int finish;
7122 XEvent event;
7124 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7126 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7127 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7128 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7129 continue;
7130 #endif
7131 event_found = 1;
7133 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7134 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7136 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7137 goto out;
7140 out:;
7142 #else /* USE_GTK */
7144 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7145 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7146 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7147 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7149 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7150 from all displays. */
7152 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7154 current_count = count;
7155 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7157 gtk_main_iteration ();
7159 count = current_count;
7160 current_count = -1;
7161 current_hold_quit = 0;
7163 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7164 break;
7166 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7168 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7169 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7170 if (! event_found)
7172 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7173 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7174 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7175 x_noop_count++;
7176 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7178 x_noop_count=0;
7180 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7181 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7183 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7185 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7186 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7190 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7191 raise it now. */
7192 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7193 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7195 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7196 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7199 --handling_signal;
7200 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7202 return count;
7208 /***********************************************************************
7209 Text Cursor
7210 ***********************************************************************/
7212 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7213 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7215 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7216 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7217 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7219 static void
7220 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7222 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7223 XRectangle clip_rect;
7224 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7226 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7228 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7229 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7230 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7231 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7232 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7234 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7238 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7240 static void
7241 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7243 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7244 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7245 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7246 int x, y, wd, h;
7247 XGCValues xgcv;
7248 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7249 GC gc;
7251 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7252 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7253 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7254 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7255 return;
7257 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7258 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7259 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7261 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7262 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7263 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7264 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7265 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7266 else
7267 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7268 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7269 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7271 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7272 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7273 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7274 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7278 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7280 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7281 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7282 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7283 --gerd. */
7285 static void
7286 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7288 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7289 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7291 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7292 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7293 and mini-buffer. */
7294 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7295 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7296 return;
7298 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7299 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7300 the bar might not be in the window. */
7301 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7303 struct glyph_row *r;
7304 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7305 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7307 else
7309 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7310 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7311 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7312 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7313 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7314 XGCValues xgcv;
7316 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7317 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7318 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7319 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7320 that the glyph is legible. */
7321 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7322 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7323 else
7324 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7325 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7327 if (gc)
7328 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7329 else
7331 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7332 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7335 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7337 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7339 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7341 if (width < 0)
7342 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7343 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7345 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7347 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7348 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7349 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7350 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7352 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7353 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7354 width, row->height);
7356 else
7358 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7360 if (width < 0)
7361 width = row->height;
7363 width = min (row->height, width);
7365 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7366 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7368 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7369 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7370 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7371 row->height - width),
7372 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7375 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7380 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7382 static void
7383 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7385 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7386 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7387 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7388 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7392 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7394 static void
7395 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7397 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7398 x, y, width, height, False);
7399 #ifdef USE_GTK
7400 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7401 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7402 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7403 #endif
7407 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7409 static void
7410 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7412 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7414 if (on_p)
7416 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7417 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7419 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7420 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7421 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7422 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7424 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7425 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7427 else
7429 switch (cursor_type)
7431 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7432 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7433 break;
7435 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7436 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7437 break;
7439 case BAR_CURSOR:
7440 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7441 break;
7443 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7444 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7445 break;
7447 case NO_CURSOR:
7448 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7449 break;
7451 default:
7452 abort ();
7456 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7457 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7458 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7459 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7460 #endif
7463 #ifndef XFlush
7464 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7465 #endif
7469 /* Icons. */
7471 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7474 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7476 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7478 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7479 return 1;
7481 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7482 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7483 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7484 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7486 if (STRINGP (file))
7488 #ifdef USE_GTK
7489 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7490 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7491 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7492 return 0;
7493 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7494 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7495 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7497 else
7499 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7500 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7502 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7504 #ifdef USE_GTK
7506 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7507 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7508 return 0;
7510 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7512 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7513 if (rc != -1)
7514 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7516 #endif
7518 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7519 if (rc == -1)
7521 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7522 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7523 if (rc == -1)
7524 return 1;
7526 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7527 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7531 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7532 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7533 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7534 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7535 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7537 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7540 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7541 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7543 return 0;
7547 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7548 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7551 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7553 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7554 return 1;
7557 XTextProperty text;
7558 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7559 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7560 text.format = 8;
7561 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7562 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7565 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7566 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7567 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7568 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7570 return 0;
7573 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7575 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7576 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7578 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7579 be called from a signal handler.
7582 struct x_error_message_stack {
7583 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7584 Display *dpy;
7585 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7587 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7589 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7590 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7591 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7593 static void
7594 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7596 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7597 x_error_message->string,
7598 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7601 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7602 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7603 operating on.
7605 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7606 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7607 stored in *x_error_message.
7609 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7610 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7612 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7614 void
7615 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7617 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7619 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7620 XSync (dpy, False);
7622 data->dpy = dpy;
7623 data->string[0] = 0;
7624 data->prev = x_error_message;
7625 x_error_message = data;
7628 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7629 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7631 void
7632 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7634 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7636 BLOCK_INPUT;
7638 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7639 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7640 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7641 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7643 tmp = x_error_message;
7644 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7645 xfree (tmp);
7646 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7649 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7650 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7651 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7653 void
7654 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7656 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7657 XSync (dpy, False);
7659 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7661 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7662 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7663 x_uncatch_errors ();
7664 error (format, string);
7668 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7669 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7672 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7674 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7675 XSync (dpy, False);
7677 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7680 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7682 void
7683 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7685 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7688 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7689 * idea. --lorentey */
7690 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7692 void
7693 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7695 while (x_error_message)
7696 x_uncatch_errors ();
7698 #endif
7700 #if 0
7701 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7702 x_trace_wire (void)
7704 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7706 #endif /* ! 0 */
7709 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7710 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7711 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7712 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7713 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7715 static void
7716 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7717 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7719 #ifdef USG
7720 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7721 must reestablish each time */
7722 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7723 #endif /* USG */
7727 /************************************************************************
7728 Handling X errors
7729 ************************************************************************/
7731 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7733 static char *error_msg;
7735 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7736 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7738 static void
7739 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7741 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7742 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7743 int idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7745 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7746 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7747 handling_signal = 0;
7749 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7750 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7752 if (dpyinfo)
7754 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7755 frame on it. */
7756 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7757 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7760 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7761 that are on the dead display. */
7762 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7764 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7765 minibuf_frame
7766 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7767 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7768 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7769 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7770 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7771 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7774 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7775 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7776 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7777 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7778 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7779 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7781 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7782 trying to find a replacement. */
7783 KVAR (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Vdefault_minibuffer_frame) = Qt;
7784 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7787 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7788 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7789 if (dpyinfo)
7791 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7792 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7793 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7794 #ifdef USE_GTK
7795 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7796 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7797 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7798 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7799 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7800 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7801 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7802 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7803 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7804 error_msg);
7805 abort ();
7806 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7808 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7809 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7811 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7812 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7813 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7814 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7815 abort ();
7818 Lisp_Object tmp;
7819 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7820 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7824 if (terminal_list == 0)
7826 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7827 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7828 /* NOTREACHED */
7831 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7832 #ifdef SIGIO
7833 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7834 #endif
7835 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7836 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7838 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7839 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7841 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7842 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7844 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7845 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7846 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7847 error ("%s", error_msg);
7850 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7851 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7852 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7854 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7855 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7857 static int
7858 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7860 if (x_error_message)
7861 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7862 else
7863 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7864 return 0;
7867 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7868 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7869 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7871 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7873 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7874 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7876 static void NO_INLINE
7877 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7879 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7881 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7882 or colors that are not defined. */
7884 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7885 return;
7887 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7888 original error handler. */
7890 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7891 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7892 buf, event->request_code);
7893 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7897 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7898 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7899 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7901 static int
7902 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7904 char buf[256];
7906 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7907 DisplayString (display));
7908 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7909 return 0;
7912 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7914 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7915 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7916 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7917 FONT-OBJECT. */
7919 Lisp_Object
7920 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7922 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7924 if (fontset < 0)
7925 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7926 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7927 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7928 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7929 do. */
7930 return font_object;
7932 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7933 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7934 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7935 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7936 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7938 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7940 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7941 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7943 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7944 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7945 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7947 else
7949 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7950 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7953 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7955 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7956 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7957 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7958 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7959 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7962 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7963 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7964 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7966 BLOCK_INPUT;
7967 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7968 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7970 #endif
7972 return font_object;
7976 /***********************************************************************
7977 X Input Methods
7978 ***********************************************************************/
7980 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7982 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7984 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7985 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7986 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7988 static void
7989 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7991 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7992 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7994 BLOCK_INPUT;
7996 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7997 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7999 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8000 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8002 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8003 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8007 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8008 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8009 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8010 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8013 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8015 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8016 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8017 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8018 #endif
8020 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8021 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8023 static void
8024 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8026 XIM xim;
8028 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8029 if (use_xim)
8031 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8032 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8033 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8034 emacs_class);
8035 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8037 if (xim)
8039 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8040 XIMCallback destroy;
8041 #endif
8043 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8044 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8046 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8047 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8048 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8049 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8050 #endif
8054 else
8055 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8056 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8060 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8062 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8063 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8064 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8065 when the callback was registered. */
8067 static void
8068 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8070 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8071 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8073 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8074 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8075 return;
8077 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8079 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8080 as they have no XIC. */
8081 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8083 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8085 BLOCK_INPUT;
8086 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8088 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8090 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8091 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8092 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8094 create_frame_xic (f);
8095 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8096 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8097 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8099 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8100 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8105 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8109 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8112 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8113 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8114 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8115 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8117 static void
8118 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8120 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8121 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8122 if (use_xim)
8124 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8125 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8126 ptrdiff_t len;
8128 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8129 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8130 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8131 len = strlen (resource_name);
8132 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8133 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8134 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8135 resource_name, emacs_class,
8136 xim_instantiate_callback,
8137 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8138 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8139 least, hence the configure test. */
8140 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8141 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8142 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8143 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8145 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8149 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8151 static void
8152 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8154 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8155 if (use_xim)
8157 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8158 if (dpyinfo->display)
8159 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8160 NULL, emacs_class,
8161 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8162 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8163 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8164 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8165 if (dpyinfo->display)
8166 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8167 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8168 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8170 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8173 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8177 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8178 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8180 static void
8181 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8183 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8185 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8186 is already for the top-left corner. */
8187 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8188 return;
8190 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8191 position that fits on the screen. */
8192 if (flags & XNegative)
8193 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8194 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8197 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8199 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8200 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8201 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8203 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8204 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8205 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8206 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8207 is right, though.
8209 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8210 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8212 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8213 #endif
8215 if (flags & YNegative)
8216 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8217 - height + f->top_pos;
8220 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8221 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8222 so the flags should correspond. */
8223 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8226 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8227 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8228 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8229 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8230 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8232 void
8233 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8235 int modified_top, modified_left;
8237 if (change_gravity > 0)
8239 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8240 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8242 f->top_pos = yoff;
8243 f->left_pos = xoff;
8244 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8245 if (xoff < 0)
8246 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8247 if (yoff < 0)
8248 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8249 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8251 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8253 BLOCK_INPUT;
8254 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8256 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8257 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8259 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8261 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8262 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8263 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8264 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8265 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8268 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8269 modified_left, modified_top);
8271 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8272 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8273 ? 1 : 0);
8275 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8276 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8277 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8278 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8279 of the frame.
8281 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8282 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8283 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8285 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8286 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8287 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8288 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8289 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8290 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8292 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8295 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8296 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8297 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8298 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8299 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8301 static int
8302 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8304 Atom actual_type;
8305 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8306 int i, rc, actual_format;
8307 Window wmcheck_window;
8308 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8309 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8310 long max_len = 65536;
8311 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8312 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8313 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8315 BLOCK_INPUT;
8317 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8318 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8319 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8320 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8321 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8322 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8324 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8326 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8327 x_uncatch_errors ();
8328 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8329 return 0;
8332 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8333 XFree (tmp_data);
8335 /* Check if window exists. */
8336 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8337 x_sync (f);
8338 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8340 x_uncatch_errors ();
8341 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8342 return 0;
8345 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8347 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8348 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8349 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8350 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8351 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8352 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8354 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8355 tmp_data = NULL;
8356 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8357 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8358 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8359 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8360 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8362 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8364 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8365 x_uncatch_errors ();
8366 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8367 return 0;
8370 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8371 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8372 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8375 rc = 0;
8377 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8378 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8380 x_uncatch_errors ();
8381 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8383 return rc;
8386 static void
8387 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8389 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8391 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8392 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8393 make_number (32),
8394 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8395 Fcons
8396 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8397 Fcons
8398 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8399 value != 0
8400 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8401 : Qnil)));
8404 void
8405 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8407 Lisp_Object frame;
8408 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8410 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8412 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8413 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8416 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8417 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8418 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not. */
8420 static void
8421 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8422 Window window,
8423 int *size_state,
8424 int *sticky)
8426 Atom actual_type;
8427 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8428 int i, rc, actual_format;
8429 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8430 long max_len = 65536;
8431 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8432 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8433 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8435 *sticky = 0;
8436 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8438 BLOCK_INPUT;
8439 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8440 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8441 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8442 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8443 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8445 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8447 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8448 x_uncatch_errors ();
8449 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8450 return;
8453 x_uncatch_errors ();
8455 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8457 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8458 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8460 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8461 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8462 else
8463 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8465 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8467 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8468 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8469 else
8470 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8472 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8473 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8474 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8475 *sticky = 1;
8478 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8479 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8482 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8484 static int
8485 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8487 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8488 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8489 int cur, dummy;
8491 get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8493 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8494 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8495 if (!have_net_atom)
8496 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8498 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8500 Lisp_Object frame;
8502 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8504 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8505 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8506 are sent at once. */
8507 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8509 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8510 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8511 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8512 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8513 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8514 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8515 break;
8516 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8517 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8518 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8519 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8520 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8521 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8522 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8523 break;
8524 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8525 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8526 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8527 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8528 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8529 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8530 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8531 break;
8532 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8533 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8534 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8535 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8536 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8537 break;
8538 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8539 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8540 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8541 else
8542 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8543 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8546 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8550 return have_net_atom;
8553 static void
8554 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8556 if (f->async_visible)
8558 BLOCK_INPUT;
8559 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8560 x_sync (f);
8561 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8566 static void
8567 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8569 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8570 Lisp_Object lval;
8571 int sticky = 0;
8573 get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8574 lval = Qnil;
8575 switch (value)
8577 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8578 lval = Qfullwidth;
8579 break;
8580 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8581 lval = Qfullheight;
8582 break;
8583 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8584 lval = Qfullboth;
8585 break;
8586 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8587 lval = Qmaximized;
8588 break;
8591 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8592 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8595 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8596 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8597 static void
8598 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8600 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8601 return;
8603 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8604 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8606 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8607 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8608 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8610 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8612 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8613 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8615 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8617 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8618 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8619 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8620 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8621 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8622 break;
8623 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8624 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8625 break;
8626 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8627 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8630 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8631 width, height);
8635 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8636 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8637 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8638 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8639 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8640 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8641 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8643 static void
8644 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8646 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8648 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8649 window manager window around the frame. */
8651 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8653 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8655 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8657 int adjusted_left;
8658 int adjusted_top;
8660 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8661 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8662 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8664 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8666 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8667 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8669 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8670 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8672 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8674 else
8675 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8676 frame's position. */
8678 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8682 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8683 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8684 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8685 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8686 of an exact comparison. */
8688 static void
8689 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8691 int count = 0;
8693 while (count++ < 50)
8695 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8697 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8698 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8699 loop. */
8701 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8702 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8704 if (fuzzy)
8706 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8707 pixels. */
8709 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8710 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8711 return;
8713 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8714 return;
8717 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8718 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8720 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8724 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8725 void
8726 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8728 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8730 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8731 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8732 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8734 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8735 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8737 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8738 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8739 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8740 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8741 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8743 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8745 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8746 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8747 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8748 BLOCK_INPUT;
8749 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8751 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8752 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8754 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8755 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8757 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8758 break; /* Timeout */
8760 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8761 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8765 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8766 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8767 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8768 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8770 static void
8771 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8773 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8775 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8776 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8777 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8779 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8781 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8783 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8784 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8785 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8786 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8788 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8789 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8790 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8791 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8794 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8795 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8796 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8797 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8798 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8800 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8801 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8802 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8803 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8805 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8806 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8807 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8808 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8809 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8811 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8812 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8814 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8815 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8816 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8817 if (f->async_visible)
8818 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8819 else
8821 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8822 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8823 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8824 x_sync (f);
8829 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8830 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8831 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8832 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8834 void
8835 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8837 BLOCK_INPUT;
8839 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8841 int r, c;
8843 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8844 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8845 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8846 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8847 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8848 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8849 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8850 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8851 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8852 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8853 is however. */
8854 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8855 #endif
8856 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8857 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8858 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8859 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8860 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8861 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8862 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8865 #ifdef USE_GTK
8866 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8867 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8868 else
8869 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8870 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8872 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8874 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8876 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8877 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8879 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8880 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8881 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8882 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8883 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8885 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8888 /* Mouse warping. */
8890 void
8891 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8893 int pix_x, pix_y;
8895 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8896 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8898 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8899 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8901 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8902 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8904 BLOCK_INPUT;
8906 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8907 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8908 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8911 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8913 void
8914 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8916 BLOCK_INPUT;
8918 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8919 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8920 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8923 /* Raise frame F. */
8925 void
8926 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8928 BLOCK_INPUT;
8929 if (f->async_visible)
8930 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8932 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8933 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8936 /* Lower frame F. */
8938 static void
8939 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8941 if (f->async_visible)
8943 BLOCK_INPUT;
8944 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8945 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8946 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8950 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8952 void
8953 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8955 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8956 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8958 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8959 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8961 Lisp_Object frame;
8962 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8963 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8964 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8965 make_number (32),
8966 Fcons (make_number (1),
8967 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8968 Qnil)));
8972 static void
8973 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8975 if (raise_flag)
8976 x_raise_frame (f);
8977 else
8978 x_lower_frame (f);
8981 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8983 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8985 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8987 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8989 static void
8990 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8992 unsigned long data[2];
8993 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8995 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8996 data[1] = flags;
8998 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8999 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9000 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9002 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9004 static void
9005 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9006 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9008 XEvent event;
9010 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9011 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9012 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9013 event.xclient.format = 32;
9014 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9015 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9016 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9017 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9018 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9020 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9021 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9022 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9025 /* Change of visibility. */
9027 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9028 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9029 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9030 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9031 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9032 finishes with it. */
9034 void
9035 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9037 Lisp_Object type;
9038 int original_top, original_left;
9039 int retry_count = 2;
9041 retry:
9043 BLOCK_INPUT;
9045 type = x_icon_type (f);
9046 if (!NILP (type))
9047 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9049 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9051 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9052 call x_set_offset a second time
9053 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9054 before the window gets really visible. */
9055 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9056 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9057 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9058 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9060 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9062 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9063 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9064 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9065 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9066 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9067 else
9069 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9070 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9072 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9073 #ifdef USE_GTK
9074 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9075 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9076 #else
9077 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9078 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9079 else
9080 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9081 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9082 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9085 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9087 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9088 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9089 so that incoming events are handled. */
9091 Lisp_Object frame;
9092 int count;
9093 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9094 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9095 will set it when they are handled. */
9096 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9098 original_left = f->left_pos;
9099 original_top = f->top_pos;
9101 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9102 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9104 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9106 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9107 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9108 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9109 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9111 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9112 because the window manager may choose the position
9113 and we don't want to override it. */
9115 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9116 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9117 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9118 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9119 && previously_visible)
9121 Drawable rootw;
9122 int x, y;
9123 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9125 BLOCK_INPUT;
9127 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9128 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9129 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9130 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9131 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9132 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9133 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9134 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9135 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9137 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9138 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9139 original_left, original_top);
9141 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9144 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9146 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9147 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9148 MapNotify at all.. */
9149 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9150 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9152 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9153 x_sync (f);
9155 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9156 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9157 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9158 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9159 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9160 probably a bug. */
9161 if (input_polling_used ())
9163 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9164 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9165 handler reset it. */
9166 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9167 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9168 poll_for_input_1 ();
9169 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9172 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9173 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9176 /* 2000-09-28: In
9178 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9179 (iconify-frame f)
9180 (raise-frame f))
9182 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9183 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9184 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9185 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9187 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9188 goto retry;
9192 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9194 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9196 void
9197 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9199 Window window;
9201 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9202 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9204 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9205 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9206 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9208 BLOCK_INPUT;
9210 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9211 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9212 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9213 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9214 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9215 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9217 #ifdef USE_GTK
9218 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9219 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9220 else
9221 #else
9222 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9223 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9224 else
9225 #endif
9228 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9229 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9231 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9232 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9236 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9237 just by the event that we get from the server.
9238 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9239 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9240 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9241 f->visible = 0;
9242 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9243 f->async_visible = 0;
9244 f->async_iconified = 0;
9246 x_sync (f);
9248 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9251 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9253 void
9254 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9256 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9257 int result;
9258 #endif
9259 Lisp_Object type;
9261 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9262 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9263 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9265 if (f->async_iconified)
9266 return;
9268 BLOCK_INPUT;
9270 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9272 type = x_icon_type (f);
9273 if (!NILP (type))
9274 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9276 #ifdef USE_GTK
9277 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9279 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9280 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9282 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9283 f->iconified = 1;
9284 f->visible = 1;
9285 f->async_iconified = 1;
9286 f->async_visible = 0;
9287 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9288 return;
9290 #endif
9292 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9294 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9296 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9297 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9298 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9299 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9300 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9301 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9302 so we have to record it here. */
9303 f->iconified = 1;
9304 f->visible = 1;
9305 f->async_iconified = 1;
9306 f->async_visible = 0;
9307 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9308 return;
9311 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9312 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9313 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9314 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9316 if (!result)
9317 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9319 f->async_iconified = 1;
9320 f->async_visible = 0;
9323 BLOCK_INPUT;
9324 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9325 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9326 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9328 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9329 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9330 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9331 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9332 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9333 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9335 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9336 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9338 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9339 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9341 XEvent msg;
9343 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9344 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9345 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9346 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9347 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9349 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9350 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9351 False,
9352 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9353 &msg))
9355 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9356 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9360 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9361 IconicState. */
9362 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9364 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9366 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9367 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9370 f->async_iconified = 1;
9371 f->async_visible = 0;
9373 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9374 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9375 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9379 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9381 void
9382 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9384 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9385 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9386 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9387 Lisp_Object bar;
9388 struct scroll_bar *b;
9389 #endif
9391 BLOCK_INPUT;
9393 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9394 commands to the X server. */
9395 if (dpyinfo->display)
9397 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9398 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9399 face. */
9400 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9401 free_frame_faces (f);
9403 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9404 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9406 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9407 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9408 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9409 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9410 toolkit scroll bars. */
9411 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9413 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9414 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9416 #endif
9418 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9419 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9420 free_frame_xic (f);
9421 #endif
9423 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9424 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9426 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9427 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9429 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9430 we are using a toolkit. */
9431 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9432 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9434 free_frame_menubar (f);
9435 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9437 #ifdef USE_GTK
9438 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9439 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9441 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9442 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9443 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9445 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9446 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9447 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9448 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9449 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9450 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9452 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9453 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9454 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9455 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9456 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9457 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9458 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9459 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9460 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9461 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9462 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9463 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9464 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9465 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9466 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9468 x_free_gcs (f);
9469 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9472 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9473 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9474 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9476 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9477 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9478 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9479 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9480 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9481 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9483 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9485 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9486 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9487 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9488 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9489 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9490 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9491 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9494 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9498 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9500 static void
9501 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9503 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9505 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9506 commands to the X server. */
9507 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9508 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9510 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9514 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9516 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9517 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9518 that the window now has.
9519 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9520 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9521 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9523 #ifndef USE_GTK
9524 void
9525 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9527 XSizeHints size_hints;
9528 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9530 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9531 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9533 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9534 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9536 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9537 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9539 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9540 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9541 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9542 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9543 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9544 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9546 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9548 int base_width, base_height;
9549 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9551 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9552 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9554 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9556 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9557 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9558 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9559 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9560 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9562 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9563 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9564 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9566 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9567 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9568 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9569 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9570 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9573 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9574 if (flags)
9576 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9577 goto no_read;
9581 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9582 long supplied_return;
9583 int value;
9585 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9586 &supplied_return);
9588 if (flags)
9589 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9590 else
9592 if (value == 0)
9593 hints.flags = 0;
9594 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9595 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9596 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9597 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9598 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9599 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9600 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9601 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9605 no_read:
9607 #ifdef PWinGravity
9608 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9609 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9611 if (user_position)
9613 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9614 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9616 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9618 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9620 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9622 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9624 static void
9625 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9627 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9628 Arg al[1];
9630 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9631 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9632 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9633 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9635 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9636 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9638 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9639 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9642 static void
9643 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9645 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9647 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9648 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9649 #endif
9651 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9653 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9654 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9655 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9656 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9658 else
9660 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9661 pixmap. */
9662 return;
9666 #ifdef USE_GTK
9668 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9669 return;
9672 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9675 Arg al[1];
9676 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9677 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9678 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9679 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9682 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9684 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9685 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9687 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9690 void
9691 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9693 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9695 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9696 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9697 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9699 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9703 /***********************************************************************
9704 Fonts
9705 ***********************************************************************/
9707 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9709 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9710 font table. */
9712 static void
9713 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9715 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9716 if (font->driver->check)
9717 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9720 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9723 /***********************************************************************
9724 Initialization
9725 ***********************************************************************/
9727 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9728 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9729 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9730 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9732 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9733 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9734 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9736 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9737 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9738 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9739 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9740 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9741 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9742 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9745 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9747 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9749 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9751 static int x_initialized;
9753 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9754 the screen number from the server number. */
9755 static int
9756 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9758 int seen_colon = 0;
9759 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9760 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9761 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9763 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9764 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9765 length_until_period++;
9767 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9768 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9769 name1 += 4;
9770 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9771 name2 += 4;
9772 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9773 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9774 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9775 name1 += system_name_length;
9776 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9777 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9778 name2 += system_name_length;
9779 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9780 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9781 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9782 name1 += length_until_period;
9783 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9784 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9785 name2 += length_until_period;
9787 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9789 if (*name1 == ':')
9790 seen_colon = 1;
9791 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9792 return 1;
9794 return (seen_colon
9795 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9796 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9799 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9800 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9801 to 5. */
9802 static void
9803 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9805 int nr = 0;
9806 int off = 0;
9808 while (!(mask & 1))
9810 off++;
9811 mask >>= 1;
9814 while (mask & 1)
9816 nr++;
9817 mask >>= 1;
9820 *offset = off;
9821 *bits = nr;
9824 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9825 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9828 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9830 int dpy_ok = 1;
9831 Display *dpy;
9833 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9834 if (dpy)
9835 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9836 else
9837 dpy_ok = 0;
9838 return dpy_ok;
9841 #ifdef USE_GTK
9842 static void
9843 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9844 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9846 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9847 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9849 #endif
9851 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9852 the structure that describes the open display.
9853 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9855 struct x_display_info *
9856 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9858 int connection;
9859 Display *dpy;
9860 struct terminal *terminal;
9861 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9862 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9863 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9864 ptrdiff_t lim;
9866 BLOCK_INPUT;
9868 if (!x_initialized)
9870 x_initialize ();
9871 ++x_initialized;
9874 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9875 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9877 #ifdef USE_GTK
9879 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9880 int argc;
9881 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9882 char **argv2 = argv;
9883 guint id;
9885 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9887 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9889 else
9891 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9892 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9894 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9895 argv[argc] = 0;
9897 argc = 0;
9898 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9900 if (! NILP (display_name))
9902 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9903 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9906 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9907 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9909 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9911 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9912 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9914 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
9915 putenv (fix_events);
9918 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9919 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9920 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9921 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9922 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9923 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9925 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9926 fixup_locale ();
9927 xg_initialize ();
9929 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9931 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9932 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9934 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9935 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9937 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9938 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9940 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
9941 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9943 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9944 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9946 #endif
9948 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9949 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9952 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9953 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9954 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9955 errors with X11R5:
9956 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9957 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9958 So let's not use it until R6. */
9959 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9960 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9961 #endif
9964 int argc = 0;
9965 char *argv[3];
9967 argv[0] = "";
9968 argc = 1;
9969 if (xrm_option)
9971 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9972 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9974 turn_on_atimers (0);
9975 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9976 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9977 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9978 &argc, argv);
9979 turn_on_atimers (1);
9981 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9982 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9983 fixup_locale ();
9984 #endif
9987 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9988 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9989 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
9990 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9991 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9993 /* Detect failure. */
9994 if (dpy == 0)
9996 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9997 return 0;
10000 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10002 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10003 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10004 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10006 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10009 struct x_display_info *share;
10010 Lisp_Object tail;
10012 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10013 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10014 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10015 SSDATA (display_name)))
10016 break;
10017 if (share)
10018 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10019 else
10021 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10022 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10023 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vwindow_system) = Qx;
10025 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10026 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10027 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10028 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10029 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10031 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10033 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10035 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10036 list of terminals. */
10037 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10038 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10039 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10040 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10042 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10043 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10044 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10045 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vsystem_key_alist)
10046 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10047 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10048 BLOCK_INPUT;
10049 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10050 terminal_list = terminal;
10051 UNGCPRO;
10054 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10055 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10056 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10057 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10058 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10060 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10063 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10064 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10065 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10067 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10068 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10069 x_display_name_list);
10070 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10072 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10074 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10075 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10076 strncpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10077 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10079 #if 0
10080 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10081 #endif /* ! 0 */
10083 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10084 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10085 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10086 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10087 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10088 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10089 + 2);
10090 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10091 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10093 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10094 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10096 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10097 #ifdef USE_GTK
10098 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10099 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10100 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10102 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10103 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10105 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10106 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10107 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10108 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10109 #else
10110 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10111 #endif
10112 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10113 all versions. */
10114 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10116 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10117 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10118 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10119 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10120 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10121 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10122 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10123 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10124 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10125 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10126 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10127 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10128 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10129 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10130 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10131 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10132 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10133 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10134 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10135 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10136 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10137 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10138 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10139 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10140 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10141 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10142 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10143 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10145 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10146 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10147 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10149 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10151 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10152 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10153 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10154 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10155 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10156 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10159 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10160 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10162 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10164 Lisp_Object value;
10165 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10166 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10167 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10168 Qnil, Qnil);
10169 if (STRINGP (value)
10170 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10171 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10172 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10175 else
10176 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10177 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10179 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10181 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10182 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10183 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10184 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10185 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10186 for example). */
10187 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10188 double d;
10189 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10190 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10192 #endif
10194 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10196 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10197 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10198 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10199 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10200 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10201 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10202 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10203 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10204 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10208 const struct
10210 const char *name;
10211 Atom *atom;
10212 } atom_refs[] = {
10213 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10214 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10215 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10216 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10217 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10218 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10219 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10220 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10221 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10222 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10223 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10224 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10225 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10226 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10227 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10228 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10229 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10230 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10231 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10232 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10233 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10234 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10235 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10236 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10237 /* For properties of font. */
10238 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10239 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10240 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10241 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10242 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10243 /* Ghostscript support. */
10244 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10245 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10246 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10247 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10248 /* EWMH */
10249 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10250 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10251 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10252 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10253 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10254 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10255 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10256 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10257 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10258 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10259 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10260 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10261 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10262 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10263 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10264 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10265 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10266 /* Session management */
10267 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10268 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10269 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10272 int i;
10273 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10274 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10275 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10276 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (sizeof (Atom) * total_atom_count);
10277 char **atom_names = xmalloc (sizeof (char *) * total_atom_count);
10278 char xsettings_atom_name[64];
10280 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10281 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10283 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10284 snprintf (xsettings_atom_name, sizeof (xsettings_atom_name),
10285 "_XSETTINGS_S%d", XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10286 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10288 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10289 False, atoms_return);
10291 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10292 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10294 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10295 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10297 xfree (atom_names);
10298 xfree (atoms_return);
10301 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10302 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10303 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10304 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10306 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10307 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10308 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10310 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10311 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10314 dpyinfo->gray
10315 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10316 gray_bitmap_bits,
10317 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10318 1, 0, 1);
10321 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10322 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10323 #endif
10325 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10327 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10328 if (connection != 0)
10329 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10331 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10332 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10333 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10335 #ifdef SIGIO
10336 if (interrupt_input)
10337 init_sigio (connection);
10338 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10340 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10342 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10343 Font font;
10345 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10346 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10347 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10348 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10349 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10350 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10351 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10352 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10353 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10354 abort ();
10355 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10356 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10357 x_uncatch_errors ();
10359 #endif
10361 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10362 for debugging X code. */
10364 Lisp_Object value;
10365 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10366 build_string ("synchronous"),
10367 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10368 Qnil, Qnil);
10369 if (STRINGP (value)
10370 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10371 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10372 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10376 Lisp_Object value;
10377 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10378 build_string ("useXIM"),
10379 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10380 Qnil, Qnil);
10381 #ifdef USE_XIM
10382 if (STRINGP (value)
10383 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10384 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10385 use_xim = 0;
10386 #else
10387 if (STRINGP (value)
10388 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10389 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10390 use_xim = 1;
10391 #endif
10394 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10395 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10396 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10397 tty. */
10398 if (terminal->id == 1)
10399 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10400 #endif
10402 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10404 return dpyinfo;
10407 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10408 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10410 static void
10411 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10413 struct terminal *t;
10415 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10416 X display. */
10417 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10418 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10420 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10421 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10422 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10423 x_session_close ();
10424 #endif
10425 delete_terminal (t);
10426 break;
10429 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10431 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10432 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10433 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10434 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10435 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10436 else
10438 Lisp_Object tail;
10440 tail = x_display_name_list;
10441 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10443 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10445 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10446 break;
10448 tail = XCDR (tail);
10452 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10453 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10455 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10456 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10457 else
10459 struct x_display_info *tail;
10461 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10462 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10463 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10466 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10467 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10468 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10469 xfree (dpyinfo);
10472 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10474 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10475 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10476 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10477 that slows us down. */
10479 static void
10480 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10482 BLOCK_INPUT;
10483 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10484 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10486 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10487 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10488 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10489 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10491 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10494 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10495 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10496 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10497 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10498 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10499 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10500 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10502 void
10503 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10505 BLOCK_INPUT;
10506 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10508 EMACS_TIME interval;
10510 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10511 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10512 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10514 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10517 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10520 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10522 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10524 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10526 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10527 x_produce_glyphs,
10528 x_write_glyphs,
10529 x_insert_glyphs,
10530 x_clear_end_of_line,
10531 x_scroll_run,
10532 x_after_update_window_line,
10533 x_update_window_begin,
10534 x_update_window_end,
10535 x_cursor_to,
10536 x_flush,
10537 #ifdef XFlush
10538 x_flush,
10539 #else
10540 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10541 #endif
10542 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10543 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10544 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10545 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10546 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10547 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10548 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10549 x_draw_glyph_string,
10550 x_define_frame_cursor,
10551 x_clear_frame_area,
10552 x_draw_window_cursor,
10553 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10554 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10558 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10559 void
10560 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10562 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10564 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10565 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10566 if (!terminal->name)
10567 return;
10569 BLOCK_INPUT;
10570 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10571 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10572 X display. */
10573 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10574 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10575 #endif
10577 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10578 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10579 if (dpyinfo->display)
10581 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10582 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10584 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10585 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10586 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10587 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10589 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10590 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10591 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10592 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10593 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10594 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10595 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10596 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10597 leaks in other situations. */
10598 #if 0
10599 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10600 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10601 #else
10602 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10603 #endif
10604 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10605 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10606 closing all the displays. */
10607 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10608 #endif
10610 #ifdef USE_GTK
10611 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10612 #else
10613 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10614 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10615 #else
10616 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10617 #endif
10618 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10621 /* Mark as dead. */
10622 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10623 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10624 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10627 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10628 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10630 static struct terminal *
10631 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10633 struct terminal *terminal;
10635 terminal = create_terminal ();
10637 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10638 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10639 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10641 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10643 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10644 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10645 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10646 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10647 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10648 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10649 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10650 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10651 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10652 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10653 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10654 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10655 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10656 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10657 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10658 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10659 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10660 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10661 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10662 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10664 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10665 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10667 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10668 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10669 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10670 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10671 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10672 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10673 off the bottom. */
10675 return terminal;
10678 void
10679 x_initialize (void)
10681 baud_rate = 19200;
10683 x_noop_count = 0;
10684 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10685 any_help_event_p = 0;
10686 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10688 #ifdef USE_GTK
10689 current_count = -1;
10690 #endif
10692 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10693 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10695 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10696 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10698 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10700 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10701 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10702 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10703 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10704 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10705 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10706 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10708 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10709 #endif
10711 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10712 #ifndef USE_GTK
10713 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10714 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10715 #endif
10716 #endif
10718 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10719 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10720 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10722 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10723 original error handler. */
10724 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10725 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10727 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10729 xgselect_initialize ();
10733 void
10734 syms_of_xterm (void)
10736 x_error_message = NULL;
10738 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10739 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10741 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10742 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10744 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10745 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10747 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10748 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10750 #ifdef USE_GTK
10751 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10752 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10754 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10755 #endif
10757 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10758 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10759 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10760 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10761 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10762 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10763 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10764 sizes. */);
10765 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10767 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10768 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10769 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10770 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10771 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10772 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10773 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10775 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10776 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10777 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10778 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10779 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10780 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10781 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10782 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10783 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10785 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10786 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10787 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10788 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10789 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10790 With MS Windows, the value is t. */);
10791 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10792 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10793 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10794 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10795 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10796 #elif USE_GTK
10797 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10798 #else
10799 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10800 #endif
10801 #else
10802 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10803 #endif
10805 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10806 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10808 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10809 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10810 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10811 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10812 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10813 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10814 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10815 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10816 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10818 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10819 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10820 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10821 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10822 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10823 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10825 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10826 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10827 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10828 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10829 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10830 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10832 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10833 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10834 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10835 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10836 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10837 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10839 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10840 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10841 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10842 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10843 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10844 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10846 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10847 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10848 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10849 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10850 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10851 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10854 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */